blob: 06a5660f72ec8b8af6e3f45274d30f897074af4c [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000039#include "llvm/LLVMContext.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000040#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000041#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000042#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Dan Gohmanca178902009-07-17 20:47:02 +000043#include "llvm/Operator.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000044#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +000045#include "llvm/Analysis/MallocHelper.h"
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +000046#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000047#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
48#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
49#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000050#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +000051#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000052#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Torok Edwin7d696d82009-07-11 13:10:19 +000053#include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000054#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000055#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +000056#include "llvm/Support/IRBuilder.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000057#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000058#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Daniel Dunbarce63ffb2009-07-25 00:23:56 +000059#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000060#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000061#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000062#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000063#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000064#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000065#include <algorithm>
Torok Edwin3eaee312008-04-20 08:33:11 +000066#include <climits>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000067using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000068using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000069
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000070STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
71STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
72STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
73STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
74STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000075
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000076namespace {
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000077 /// InstCombineWorklist - This is the worklist management logic for
78 /// InstCombine.
79 class InstCombineWorklist {
80 SmallVector<Instruction*, 256> Worklist;
81 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
82
83 void operator=(const InstCombineWorklist&RHS); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT
84 InstCombineWorklist(const InstCombineWorklist&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT
85 public:
86 InstCombineWorklist() {}
87
88 bool isEmpty() const { return Worklist.empty(); }
89
90 /// Add - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it isn't already
91 /// in it.
92 void Add(Instruction *I) {
Jeffrey Yasskin43069632009-10-08 00:12:24 +000093 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())).second) {
94 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ADD: " << *I << '\n');
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000095 Worklist.push_back(I);
Jeffrey Yasskin43069632009-10-08 00:12:24 +000096 }
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000097 }
98
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +000099 void AddValue(Value *V) {
100 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
101 Add(I);
102 }
103
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000104 // Remove - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +0000105 void Remove(Instruction *I) {
106 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
107 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
108
109 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
110 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
111
112 WorklistMap.erase(It);
113 }
114
115 Instruction *RemoveOne() {
116 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
117 Worklist.pop_back();
118 WorklistMap.erase(I);
119 return I;
120 }
121
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +0000122 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
123 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
124 /// now.
125 ///
126 void AddUsersToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
127 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
128 UI != UE; ++UI)
129 Add(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
130 }
131
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +0000132
133 /// Zap - check that the worklist is empty and nuke the backing store for
134 /// the map if it is large.
135 void Zap() {
136 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
137
138 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
139 WorklistMap.clear();
140 }
141 };
142} // end anonymous namespace.
143
144
145namespace {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +0000146 /// InstCombineIRInserter - This is an IRBuilder insertion helper that works
147 /// just like the normal insertion helper, but also adds any new instructions
148 /// to the instcombine worklist.
149 class InstCombineIRInserter : public IRBuilderDefaultInserter<true> {
150 InstCombineWorklist &Worklist;
151 public:
152 InstCombineIRInserter(InstCombineWorklist &WL) : Worklist(WL) {}
153
154 void InsertHelper(Instruction *I, const Twine &Name,
155 BasicBlock *BB, BasicBlock::iterator InsertPt) const {
156 IRBuilderDefaultInserter<true>::InsertHelper(I, Name, BB, InsertPt);
157 Worklist.Add(I);
158 }
159 };
160} // end anonymous namespace
161
162
163namespace {
Chris Lattner3e8b6632009-09-02 06:11:42 +0000164 class InstCombiner : public FunctionPass,
165 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000166 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +0000167 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +0000168 bool MadeIRChange;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000169 public:
Chris Lattner75551f72009-08-30 17:53:59 +0000170 /// Worklist - All of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000171 InstCombineWorklist Worklist;
172
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +0000173 /// Builder - This is an IRBuilder that automatically inserts new
174 /// instructions into the worklist when they are created.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +0000175 typedef IRBuilder<true, ConstantFolder, InstCombineIRInserter> BuilderTy;
176 BuilderTy *Builder;
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +0000177
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +0000178 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +0000179 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass(&ID), TD(0), Builder(0) {}
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +0000180
Owen Andersone922c022009-07-22 00:24:57 +0000181 LLVMContext *Context;
182 LLVMContext *getContext() const { return Context; }
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000183
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000184 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000185 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000186
187 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000188
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000189 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000190 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000191 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000192 }
193
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000194 TargetData *getTargetData() const { return TD; }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000195
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000196 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
197 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
198 // Return Value:
199 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000200 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000201 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000202 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000203 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000204 Instruction *visitFAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000205 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000206 Instruction *visitFSub(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000207 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000208 Instruction *visitFMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000209 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
210 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
211 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +0000212 bool SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000213 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
214 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000215 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
216 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
217 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
218 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
219 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +0000220 Instruction *FoldAndOfICmps(Instruction &I, ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +0000221 Instruction *FoldAndOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS, FCmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000222 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +0000223 Instruction *FoldOrOfICmps(Instruction &I, ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +0000224 Instruction *FoldOrOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS, FCmpInst *RHS);
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +0000225 Instruction *FoldOrWithConstants(BinaryOperator &I, Value *Op,
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +0000226 Value *A, Value *B, Value *C);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000227 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
228 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000229 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
230 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
231 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
232 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000233 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
234 Constant *RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000235 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
236 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
237 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000238 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
239 Instruction *LHS,
240 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000241 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
242 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000243
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +0000244 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(GEPOperator *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000245 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000246 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000247 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000248 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
249 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000250 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000251 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
252 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
253 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000254 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000255 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000256 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
257 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000258 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
259 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000260 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(PtrToIntInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000261 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000262 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000263 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
264 Instruction *FI);
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +0000265 Instruction *FoldSelectIntoOp(SelectInst &SI, Value*, Value*);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +0000266 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI);
267 Instruction *visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI, ICmpInst *ICI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000268 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
269 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000270 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
271 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000272 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000273 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000274 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000275 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000276 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000277 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000278 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000279 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000280 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000281 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000282
283 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000284 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000285
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000286 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000287 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000288 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000289 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000290 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
291 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000292 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +0000293 DbgDeclareInst *hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Value *V);
294
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000295
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000296 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000297 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
298 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
299 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000300 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000301 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
302 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000303 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
304 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000305 Worklist.Add(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000306 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000307 }
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000308
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000309 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
310 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
311 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
312 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
313 // modified.
314 //
315 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +0000316 Worklist.AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist.
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000317
318 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
319 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
320 if (&I == V)
321 V = UndefValue::get(I.getType());
322
323 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
324 return &I;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000325 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000326
327 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
328 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
329 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
330 // this function.
331 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +0000332 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ERASE " << I << '\n');
Chris Lattner931f8f32009-08-31 05:17:58 +0000333
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000334 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000335 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
336 // use counts.
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +0000337 if (I.getNumOperands() < 8) {
338 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
339 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
340 Worklist.Add(Op);
341 }
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000342 Worklist.Remove(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000343 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +0000344 MadeIRChange = true;
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000345 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
346 }
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000347
348 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
349 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
350 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
351 }
352
353 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
354 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
355 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
356 }
357 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
358 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
359 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000360
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000361 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000362
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000363 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
364 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000365 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000366
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000367 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
368 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
369 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
370
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000371 /// SimplifyDemandedUseBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value
372 /// based on the demanded bits.
373 Value *SimplifyDemandedUseBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
374 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
375 unsigned Depth);
376 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Use &U, APInt DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000377 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000378 unsigned Depth=0);
379
380 /// SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits - Inst is an integer instruction that
381 /// SimplifyDemandedBits knows about. See if the instruction has any
382 /// properties that allow us to simplify its operands.
383 bool SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(Instruction &Inst);
384
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +0000385 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, APInt DemandedElts,
386 APInt& UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000387
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +0000388 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator, cast instruction, or select
389 // which has a PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction
390 // into the PHI (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are
391 // constants).
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +0000392 //
393 // If AllowAggressive is true, FoldOpIntoPhi will allow certain transforms
394 // that would normally be unprofitable because they strongly encourage jump
395 // threading.
396 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I, bool AllowAggressive = false);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000397
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000398 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
399 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
400 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
401 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000402 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +0000403 Instruction *FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
404
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000405
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000406 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
407 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000408
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000409 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000410 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000411 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000412 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000413 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000414 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000415 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000416 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000417 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000418
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000419
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000420 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000421
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000422 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +0000423 unsigned CastOpc, int &NumCastsRemoved);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000424 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
425 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000426
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000427 };
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +0000428} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000429
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000430char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
431static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
432X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
433
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000434// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000435// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Dan Gohman14ef4f02009-08-29 23:39:38 +0000436static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000437 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
Owen Andersonfa82b6e2009-07-13 22:18:28 +0000438 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) ||
439 BinaryOperator::isFNeg(V) ||
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000440 BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000441 return 3;
442 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000443 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000444 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
445 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000446}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000447
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000448// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
449// it.
450static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000451 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000452}
453
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000454// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
455// though a va_arg area...
456static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000457 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
458 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +0000459 return Type::getInt32Ty(Ty->getContext());
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000460 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000461 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000462}
463
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000464/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst, a constant
465/// expression bitcast, or a GetElementPtrInst with all zero indices, return the
466/// operand value, otherwise return null.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000467static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
Dan Gohman016de812009-07-17 23:55:56 +0000468 if (Operator *O = dyn_cast<Operator>(V)) {
469 if (O->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
470 return O->getOperand(0);
471 if (GEPOperator *GEP = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(V))
472 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices())
473 return GEP->getPointerOperand();
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000474 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000475 return 0;
476}
477
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000478/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
479/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000480static Instruction::CastOps
481isEliminableCastPair(
482 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
483 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
484 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
485 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
486) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000487
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000488 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
489 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000490
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000491 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
492 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
493 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000494
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000495 unsigned Res = CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000496 DstTy,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +0000497 TD ? TD->getIntPtrType(CI->getContext()) : 0);
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000498
499 // We don't want to form an inttoptr or ptrtoint that converts to an integer
500 // type that differs from the pointer size.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +0000501 if ((Res == Instruction::IntToPtr &&
Dan Gohman5e9bb732009-08-19 23:38:22 +0000502 (!TD || SrcTy != TD->getIntPtrType(CI->getContext()))) ||
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +0000503 (Res == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
Dan Gohman5e9bb732009-08-19 23:38:22 +0000504 (!TD || DstTy != TD->getIntPtrType(CI->getContext()))))
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000505 Res = 0;
506
507 return Instruction::CastOps(Res);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000508}
509
510/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
511/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
512/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000513static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
514 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000515 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
516
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000517 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000518 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000519 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000520 return false;
521 return true;
522}
523
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000524// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
525// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000526//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000527// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
528// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
529// binary operators.
530//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000531// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
532// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000533//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000534bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000535 bool Changed = false;
Dan Gohman14ef4f02009-08-29 23:39:38 +0000536 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000537 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000538
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000539 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
540 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000541 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
542 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
543 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000544 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000545 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
546 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000547 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
548 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
549 return true;
550 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
551 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
552 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
553 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
554 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
555
556 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000557 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000558 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000559 Op1->getOperand(0),
560 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +0000561 Worklist.Add(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000562 I.setOperand(0, New);
563 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
564 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000565 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000566 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000567 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000568}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000569
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000570/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
571/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
572/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
573bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
Dan Gohman14ef4f02009-08-29 23:39:38 +0000574 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000575 return false;
576 I.swapOperands();
577 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
578 return true;
579}
580
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000581// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
582// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000583//
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000584static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
Owen Andersonfa82b6e2009-07-13 22:18:28 +0000585 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000586 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000587
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000588 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
589 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000590 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000591
592 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
593 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000594 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000595
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000596 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000597}
598
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000599// dyn_castFNegVal - Given a 'fsub' instruction, return the RHS of the
600// instruction if the LHS is a constant negative zero (which is the 'negate'
601// form).
602//
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000603static inline Value *dyn_castFNegVal(Value *V) {
Owen Andersonfa82b6e2009-07-13 22:18:28 +0000604 if (BinaryOperator::isFNeg(V))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000605 return BinaryOperator::getFNegArgument(V);
606
607 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
608 if (ConstantFP *C = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000609 return ConstantExpr::getFNeg(C);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000610
611 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
612 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isFloatingPoint())
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000613 return ConstantExpr::getFNeg(C);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000614
615 return 0;
616}
617
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000618static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000619 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000620 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000621
622 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000623 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000624 return ConstantInt::get(C->getType(), ~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000625 return 0;
626}
627
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000628// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
629// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000630// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
631// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000632//
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000633static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000634 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000635 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000636 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000637 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000638 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000639 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000640 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000641 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000642 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000643 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000644 CST = ConstantInt::get(V->getType()->getContext(),
645 APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000646 return I->getOperand(0);
647 }
648 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000649 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000650}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000651
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000652/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000653static Constant *AddOne(Constant *C) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000654 return ConstantExpr::getAdd(C,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +0000655 ConstantInt::get(C->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000656}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000657/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000658static Constant *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +0000659 return ConstantExpr::getSub(C,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +0000660 ConstantInt::get(C->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000661}
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000662/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
663/// this size.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000664static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign) {
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000665 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
666 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
667 if (sign) {
668 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
669 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
670 } else {
671 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
672 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
673 }
674
675 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
676
677 if (sign) {
678 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
679 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
680 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
681 } else
682 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
683}
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000684
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000685
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000686/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
687/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
688/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
689/// constant and return true.
690static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000691 APInt Demanded) {
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000692 assert(I && "No instruction?");
693 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
694
695 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
696 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
697 if (!OpC) return false;
698
699 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
700 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
701 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
702 return false;
703
704 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
705 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000706 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(OpC->getType(), Demanded));
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000707 return true;
708}
709
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000710// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
711// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
712// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
713// min/max.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000714static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const APInt& KnownZero,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000715 const APInt& KnownOne,
716 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000717 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == KnownOne.getBitWidth() &&
718 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Min.getBitWidth() &&
719 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Max.getBitWidth() &&
720 "KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000721 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000722
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000723 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
724 // bit if it is unknown.
725 Min = KnownOne;
726 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
727
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000728 if (UnknownBits.isNegative()) { // Sign bit is unknown
729 Min.set(Min.getBitWidth()-1);
730 Max.clear(Max.getBitWidth()-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000731 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000732}
733
734// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
735// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
736// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
737// min/max.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000738static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const APInt &KnownZero,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000739 const APInt &KnownOne,
740 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000741 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == KnownOne.getBitWidth() &&
742 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Min.getBitWidth() &&
743 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Max.getBitWidth() &&
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000744 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000745 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000746
747 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
748 Min = KnownOne;
749 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
750 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
751}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000752
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000753/// SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits - Inst is an integer instruction that
754/// SimplifyDemandedBits knows about. See if the instruction has any
755/// properties that allow us to simplify its operands.
756bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(Instruction &Inst) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000757 unsigned BitWidth = Inst.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000758 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
759 APInt DemandedMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
760
761 Value *V = SimplifyDemandedUseBits(&Inst, DemandedMask,
762 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0);
763 if (V == 0) return false;
764 if (V == &Inst) return true;
765 ReplaceInstUsesWith(Inst, V);
766 return true;
767}
768
769/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This form of SimplifyDemandedBits simplifies the
770/// specified instruction operand if possible, updating it in place. It returns
771/// true if it made any change and false otherwise.
772bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Use &U, APInt DemandedMask,
773 APInt &KnownZero, APInt &KnownOne,
774 unsigned Depth) {
775 Value *NewVal = SimplifyDemandedUseBits(U.get(), DemandedMask,
776 KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
777 if (NewVal == 0) return false;
Dan Gohmane41a1152009-10-05 16:31:55 +0000778 U = NewVal;
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000779 return true;
780}
781
782
783/// SimplifyDemandedUseBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
784/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000785/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
786/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
787/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
788/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
789/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000790/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000791/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
792/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
793/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
794/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
795/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
796/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
797/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000798///
799/// This returns null if it did not change anything and it permits no
800/// simplification. This returns V itself if it did some simplification of V's
801/// operands based on the information about what bits are demanded. This returns
802/// some other non-null value if it found out that V is equal to another value
803/// in the context where the specified bits are demanded, but not for all users.
804Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedUseBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
805 APInt &KnownZero, APInt &KnownOne,
806 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000807 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
808 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
809 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000810 const Type *VTy = V->getType();
811 assert((TD || !isa<PointerType>(VTy)) &&
812 "SimplifyDemandedBits needs to know bit widths!");
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000813 assert((!TD || TD->getTypeSizeInBits(VTy->getScalarType()) == BitWidth) &&
814 (!VTy->isIntOrIntVector() ||
815 VTy->getScalarSizeInBits() == BitWidth) &&
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000816 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000817 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000818 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne "
819 "must have same BitWidth");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000820 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
821 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
822 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
823 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000824 return 0;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000825 }
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000826 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(V)) {
827 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
828 KnownOne.clear();
829 KnownZero = DemandedMask;
830 return 0;
831 }
832
Chris Lattner08d2cc72009-01-31 07:26:06 +0000833 KnownZero.clear();
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000834 KnownOne.clear();
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000835 if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
836 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
837 return 0;
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +0000838 return UndefValue::get(VTy);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000839 }
840
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +0000841 if (Depth == 6) // Limit search depth.
842 return 0;
843
Chris Lattnerd1b5e3f2009-01-31 08:40:03 +0000844 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
845 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
846
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000847 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
848 if (!I) {
849 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
850 return 0; // Only analyze instructions.
851 }
852
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +0000853 // If there are multiple uses of this value and we aren't at the root, then
854 // we can't do any simplifications of the operands, because DemandedMask
855 // only reflects the bits demanded by *one* of the users.
856 if (Depth != 0 && !I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerd1b5e3f2009-01-31 08:40:03 +0000857 // Despite the fact that we can't simplify this instruction in all User's
858 // context, we can at least compute the knownzero/knownone bits, and we can
859 // do simplifications that apply to *just* the one user if we know that
860 // this instruction has a simpler value in that context.
861 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
862 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
863 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
864 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
865 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
866 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
867
868 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
869 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and' in this
870 // context.
871 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
872 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
873 return I->getOperand(0);
874 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
875 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
876 return I->getOperand(1);
877
878 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
879 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +0000880 return Constant::getNullValue(VTy);
Chris Lattnerd1b5e3f2009-01-31 08:40:03 +0000881
882 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
883 // We can simplify (X|Y) -> X or Y in the user's context if we know that
884 // only bits from X or Y are demanded.
885
886 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
887 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
888 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
889 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
890 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
891
892 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the
893 // other. These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or' in this
894 // context.
895 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
896 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
897 return I->getOperand(0);
898 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
899 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
900 return I->getOperand(1);
901
902 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
903 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
904 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
905 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
906 return I->getOperand(0);
907 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
908 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
909 return I->getOperand(1);
910 }
911
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +0000912 // Compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
913 ComputeMaskedBits(I, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
914 return 0;
915 }
916
917 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
918 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits so that we can try to simplify the
919 // operands. This allows visitTruncInst (for example) to simplify the
920 // operand of a trunc without duplicating all the logic below.
921 if (Depth == 0 && !V->hasOneUse())
922 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
923
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000924 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000925 default:
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000926 ComputeMaskedBits(I, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000927 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000928 case Instruction::And:
929 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000930 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
931 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
932 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000933 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000934 return I;
935 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
936 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000937
938 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
939 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
940 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
941 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000942 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000943 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
944 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000945 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000946
947 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
948 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +0000949 return Constant::getNullValue(VTy);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000950
951 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000952 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000953 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000954
955 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
956 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
957 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
958 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
959 break;
960 case Instruction::Or:
961 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000962 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
963 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
964 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000965 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000966 return I;
967 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
968 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000969
970 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
971 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
972 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
973 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000974 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000975 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
976 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000977 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000978
979 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
980 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
981 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
982 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000983 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000984 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
985 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000986 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000987
988 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +0000989 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000990 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000991
992 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
993 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
994 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
995 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
996 break;
997 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000998 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
999 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1000 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001001 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001002 return I;
1003 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1004 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001005
1006 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1007 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
1008 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001009 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001010 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001011 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001012
1013 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
1014 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
1015 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
1016 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
1017 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
1018 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
1019
1020 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
1021 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
1022 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattner95afdfe2009-08-31 04:36:22 +00001023 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
1024 Instruction *Or =
1025 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1026 I->getName());
1027 return InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1028 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001029
1030 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
1031 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
1032 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
1033 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
1034 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
1035 // all known
1036 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
Dan Gohman43ee5f72009-08-03 22:07:33 +00001037 Constant *AndC = Constant::getIntegerValue(VTy,
1038 ~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001039 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001040 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001041 return InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001042 }
1043 }
1044
1045 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1046 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00001047 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001048 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001049
1050 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
1051 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
1052 break;
1053 }
1054 case Instruction::Select:
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001055 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(2), DemandedMask,
1056 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1057 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001058 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001059 return I;
1060 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1061 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001062
1063 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00001064 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask) ||
1065 ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001066 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001067
1068 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
1069 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
1070 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1071 break;
1072 case Instruction::Trunc: {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00001073 unsigned truncBf = I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001074 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
1075 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1076 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001077 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001078 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001079 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001080 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1081 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1082 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001083 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001084 break;
1085 }
1086 case Instruction::BitCast:
Dan Gohman6cc18fe2009-07-01 21:38:46 +00001087 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isIntOrIntVector())
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001088 return false; // vector->int or fp->int?
Dan Gohman6cc18fe2009-07-01 21:38:46 +00001089
1090 if (const VectorType *DstVTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getType())) {
1091 if (const VectorType *SrcVTy =
1092 dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
1093 if (DstVTy->getNumElements() != SrcVTy->getNumElements())
1094 // Don't touch a bitcast between vectors of different element counts.
1095 return false;
1096 } else
1097 // Don't touch a scalar-to-vector bitcast.
1098 return false;
1099 } else if (isa<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType()))
1100 // Don't touch a vector-to-scalar bitcast.
1101 return false;
1102
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001103 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001104 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001105 return I;
1106 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001107 break;
1108 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1109 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00001110 unsigned SrcBitWidth =I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001111
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001112 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1113 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1114 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001115 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001116 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001117 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001118 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1119 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1120 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001121 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001122 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001123 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001124 break;
1125 }
1126 case Instruction::SExt: {
1127 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00001128 unsigned SrcBitWidth =I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001129
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001130 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001131 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001132
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001133 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001134 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1135 // bit is demanded.
1136 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001137 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001138
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001139 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1140 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1141 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001142 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), InputDemandedBits,
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001143 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001144 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001145 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1146 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1147 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001148 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001149
1150 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1151 // top bits of the result.
1152
1153 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1154 // convert this into a zero extension.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001155 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001156 // Convert to ZExt cast
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001157 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName());
1158 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *I);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001159 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001160 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001161 }
1162 break;
1163 }
1164 case Instruction::Add: {
1165 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1166 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1167 // either.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001168 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001169
1170 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1171 // we can do.
1172 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1173 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1174 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1175 if (RHS->isZero())
1176 break;
1177
1178 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1179 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001180 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001181
1182 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001183 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), InDemandedBits,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001184 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001185 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001186
1187 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1188 // the constant.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00001189 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001190 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001191
1192 // Avoid excess work.
1193 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1194 break;
1195
1196 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1197 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1198 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001199 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001200 I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001201 return InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001202 }
1203
1204 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1205 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1206 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1207 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1208 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1209
1210 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1211 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1212 // this scan.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001213 const APInt &RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001214 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001215
1216 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1217
1218 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1219 // other, and there is no input carry.
1220 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1221 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1222
1223 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1224 // is no input carry.
1225 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1226 } else {
1227 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1228 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001229 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001230 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1231 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001232 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001233 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedFromOps,
1234 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1235 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedFromOps,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001236 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001237 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001238 }
1239 }
1240 break;
1241 }
1242 case Instruction::Sub:
1243 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1244 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001245 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001246 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1247 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001248 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001249 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001250 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedFromOps,
1251 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1252 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedFromOps,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001253 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001254 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001255 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001256 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1257 // the known zeros and ones.
1258 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001259 break;
1260 case Instruction::Shl:
1261 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001262 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001263 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001264 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001265 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001266 return I;
1267 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001268 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1269 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1270 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001271 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001272 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001273 }
1274 break;
1275 case Instruction::LShr:
1276 // For a logical shift right
1277 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001278 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001279
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001280 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001281 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001282 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001283 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001284 return I;
1285 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001286 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1287 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001288 if (ShiftAmt) {
1289 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001290 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001291 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1292 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001293 }
1294 break;
1295 case Instruction::AShr:
1296 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1297 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1298 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1299 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1300 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1301 // Perform the logical shift right.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001302 Instruction *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001303 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001304 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001305 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001306
1307 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1308 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1309 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001310 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001311
1312 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001313 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001314
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001315 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001316 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001317 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1318 // demanded.
1319 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1320 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001321 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001322 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001323 return I;
1324 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001325 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001326 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001327 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1328 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1329
1330 // Handle the sign bits.
1331 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1332 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1333 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1334
1335 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1336 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shengcc419402008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001337 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001338 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1339 // Perform the logical shift right.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001340 Instruction *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001341 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001342 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001343 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1344 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1345 }
1346 }
1347 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001348 case Instruction::SRem:
1349 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001350 APInt RA = Rem->getValue().abs();
1351 if (RA.isPowerOf2()) {
Eli Friedmana999a512009-06-17 02:57:36 +00001352 if (DemandedMask.ult(RA)) // srem won't affect demanded bits
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001353 return I->getOperand(0);
Nick Lewycky3ac9e102008-07-12 05:04:38 +00001354
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001355 APInt LowBits = RA - 1;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001356 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001357 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), Mask2,
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001358 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001359 return I;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001360
1361 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1362 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001363
1364 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001365
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001366 assert(!(KnownZero & KnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001367 }
1368 }
1369 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001370 case Instruction::URem: {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001371 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1372 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001373 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), AllOnes,
1374 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1) ||
1375 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001376 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001377 return I;
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001378
Chris Lattner455e9ab2009-01-21 18:09:24 +00001379 unsigned Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001380 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1381 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1382 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001383 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001384 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001385 case Instruction::Call:
1386 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1387 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1388 default: break;
1389 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1390 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1391 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1392 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1393 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1394
1395 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1396 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1397 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1398 NLZ &= ~7;
1399 NTZ &= ~7;
1400 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1401 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1402 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1403 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1404
1405 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1406 // the right place.
1407 Instruction *NewVal;
1408 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1409 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00001410 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001411 else
1412 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00001413 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001414 NewVal->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001415 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001416 }
1417
1418 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1419 break;
1420 }
1421 }
1422 }
Chris Lattner6c3bfba2008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001423 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001424 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001425 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001426
1427 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1428 // constant.
Dan Gohman43ee5f72009-08-03 22:07:33 +00001429 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1430 return Constant::getIntegerValue(VTy, RHSKnownOne);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001431 return false;
1432}
1433
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001434
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001435/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value produces a vector with
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001436/// any number of elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001437/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1438/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1439///
1440/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1441/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1442/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001443Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, APInt DemandedElts,
1444 APInt& UndefElts,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001445 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001446 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001447 APInt EltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001448 assert((DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 && "Invalid DemandedElts!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001449
1450 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1451 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1452 UndefElts = EltMask;
1453 return 0;
1454 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1455 UndefElts = EltMask;
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00001456 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001457 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001458
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001459 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001460 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1461 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00001462 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001463
1464 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1465 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001466 if (!DemandedElts[i]) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001467 Elts.push_back(Undef);
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001468 UndefElts.set(i);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001469 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1470 Elts.push_back(Undef);
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001471 UndefElts.set(i);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001472 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1473 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1474 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001475
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001476 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00001477 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001478 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1479 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001480 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001481 // set to undef.
Mon P Wange0b436a2008-11-06 22:52:21 +00001482
1483 // Check if this is identity. If so, return 0 since we are not simplifying
1484 // anything.
1485 if (DemandedElts == ((1ULL << VWidth) -1))
1486 return 0;
1487
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001488 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00001489 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00001490 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001491 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001492 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i) {
1493 Constant *Elt = DemandedElts[i] ? Zero : Undef;
1494 Elts.push_back(Elt);
1495 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001496 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00001497 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001498 }
1499
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001500 // Limit search depth.
1501 if (Depth == 10)
Dan Gohman2fe4d0a2009-04-25 17:28:45 +00001502 return 0;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001503
1504 // If multiple users are using the root value, procede with
1505 // simplification conservatively assuming that all elements
1506 // are needed.
1507 if (!V->hasOneUse()) {
1508 // Quit if we find multiple users of a non-root value though.
1509 // They'll be handled when it's their turn to be visited by
1510 // the main instcombine process.
1511 if (Depth != 0)
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001512 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
Dan Gohman2fe4d0a2009-04-25 17:28:45 +00001513 return 0;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001514
1515 // Conservatively assume that all elements are needed.
1516 DemandedElts = EltMask;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001517 }
1518
1519 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Dan Gohman2fe4d0a2009-04-25 17:28:45 +00001520 if (!I) return 0; // Only analyze instructions.
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001521
1522 bool MadeChange = false;
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001523 APInt UndefElts2(VWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001524 Value *TmpV;
1525 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1526 default: break;
1527
1528 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1529 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1530 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001531 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001532 if (Idx == 0) {
1533 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1534 // which elt is getting updated.
1535 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1536 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1537 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1538 break;
1539 }
1540
1541 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1542 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001543 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerc3a3e362009-08-30 06:20:05 +00001544 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || !DemandedElts[IdxNo]) {
1545 Worklist.Add(I);
1546 return I->getOperand(0);
1547 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001548
1549 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1550 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001551 APInt DemandedElts2 = DemandedElts;
1552 DemandedElts2.clear(IdxNo);
1553 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts2,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001554 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1555 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1556
1557 // The inserted element is defined.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001558 UndefElts.clear(IdxNo);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001559 break;
1560 }
1561 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
1562 ShuffleVectorInst *Shuffle = cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001563 uint64_t LHSVWidth =
1564 cast<VectorType>(Shuffle->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001565 APInt LeftDemanded(LHSVWidth, 0), RightDemanded(LHSVWidth, 0);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001566 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001567 if (DemandedElts[i]) {
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001568 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
1569 if (MaskVal != -1u) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001570 assert(MaskVal < LHSVWidth * 2 &&
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001571 "shufflevector mask index out of range!");
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001572 if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001573 LeftDemanded.set(MaskVal);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001574 else
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001575 RightDemanded.set(MaskVal - LHSVWidth);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001576 }
1577 }
1578 }
1579
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001580 APInt UndefElts4(LHSVWidth, 0);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001581 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), LeftDemanded,
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001582 UndefElts4, Depth+1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001583 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1584
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001585 APInt UndefElts3(LHSVWidth, 0);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001586 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), RightDemanded,
1587 UndefElts3, Depth+1);
1588 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1589
1590 bool NewUndefElts = false;
1591 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1592 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
Dan Gohmancb893092008-09-10 01:09:32 +00001593 if (MaskVal == -1u) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001594 UndefElts.set(i);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001595 } else if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth) {
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001596 if (UndefElts4[MaskVal]) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001597 NewUndefElts = true;
1598 UndefElts.set(i);
1599 }
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001600 } else {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001601 if (UndefElts3[MaskVal - LHSVWidth]) {
1602 NewUndefElts = true;
1603 UndefElts.set(i);
1604 }
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001605 }
1606 }
1607
1608 if (NewUndefElts) {
1609 // Add additional discovered undefs.
1610 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1611 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; ++i) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001612 if (UndefElts[i])
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001613 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001614 else
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001615 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context),
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001616 Shuffle->getMaskValue(i)));
1617 }
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00001618 I->setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001619 MadeChange = true;
1620 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001621 break;
1622 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001623 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001624 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001625 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1626 if (!VTy) break;
1627 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001628 APInt InputDemandedElts(InVWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001629 unsigned Ratio;
1630
1631 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001632 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001633 // elements as are demanded of us.
1634 Ratio = 1;
1635 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1636 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1637 // Untested so far.
1638 break;
1639
1640 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1641 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1642 // elements are live.
1643 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1644 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001645 if (DemandedElts[OutIdx])
1646 InputDemandedElts.set(OutIdx/Ratio);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001647 }
1648 } else {
1649 // Untested so far.
1650 break;
1651
1652 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1653 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1654 // live.
1655 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1656 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001657 if (DemandedElts[InIdx/Ratio])
1658 InputDemandedElts.set(InIdx);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001659 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001660
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001661 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1662 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1663 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1664 if (TmpV) {
1665 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1666 MadeChange = true;
1667 }
1668
1669 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1670 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001671 llvm_unreachable("Unimp");
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001672 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1673 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1674 // undef.
1675 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001676 if (UndefElts2[OutIdx/Ratio])
1677 UndefElts.set(OutIdx);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001678 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001679 llvm_unreachable("Unimp");
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001680 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1681 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1682 // elements are undef.
1683 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1684 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001685 if (!UndefElts2[InIdx]) // Not undef?
1686 UndefElts.clear(InIdx/Ratio); // Clear undef bit.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001687 }
1688 break;
1689 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001690 case Instruction::And:
1691 case Instruction::Or:
1692 case Instruction::Xor:
1693 case Instruction::Add:
1694 case Instruction::Sub:
1695 case Instruction::Mul:
1696 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1697 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1698 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1699 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1700 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1701 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1702 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1703
1704 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1705 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1706 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1707 break;
1708
1709 case Instruction::Call: {
1710 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1711 if (!II) break;
1712 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1713 default: break;
1714
1715 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1716 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1717 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1718 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1719 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1720 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1721 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1722 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1723 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1724 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1725 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1726 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1727 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1728 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1729 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1730 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1731
1732 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1733 // scalarize it now.
1734 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1735 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1736 default: break;
1737 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1738 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1739 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1740 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1741 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1742 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1743 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1744 // Extract the element as scalars.
Eric Christophera3500da2009-07-25 02:28:41 +00001745 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(ExtractElementInst::Create(LHS,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001746 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0U, false), "tmp"), *II);
Eric Christophera3500da2009-07-25 02:28:41 +00001747 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(ExtractElementInst::Create(RHS,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001748 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0U, false), "tmp"), *II);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001749
1750 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001751 default: llvm_unreachable("Case stmts out of sync!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001752 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1753 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00001754 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001755 II->getName()), *II);
1756 break;
1757 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1758 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00001759 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateFMul(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001760 II->getName()), *II);
1761 break;
1762 }
1763
1764 Instruction *New =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001765 InsertElementInst::Create(
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00001766 UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001767 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0U, false), II->getName());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001768 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001769 return New;
1770 }
1771 }
1772
1773 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1774 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1775 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1776 break;
1777 }
1778 break;
1779 }
1780 }
1781 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1782}
1783
Dan Gohman45b4e482008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001784
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001785/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1786/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1787/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1788/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1789/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1790/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1791/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1792///
1793template<typename Functor>
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00001794static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001795 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1796 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1797
1798 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1799 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1800 return F.apply(Root);
1801
1802 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1803 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001804 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001805 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1806 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1807
1808 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1809 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1810 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1811 ShouldApply = true;
1812 }
1813
1814 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1815 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1816 if (ShouldApply) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001817 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1818 // and perform the reassociation.
1819 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1820
1821 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1822 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1823
1824 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1825 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001826 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00001827 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001828 return 0;
1829 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001830 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001831 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001832 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001833 TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001834 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001835
1836 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1837 // get to LHSI.
1838 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1839 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001840 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1841 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001842 NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001843 ARI = NextLHSI;
1844
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001845 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1846 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1847 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1848 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1849 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001850
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001851 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1852 // the transformation...
1853 return F.apply(Root);
1854 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001855
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001856 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1857 }
1858 return 0;
1859}
1860
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001861namespace {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001862
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001863// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001864struct AddRHS {
1865 Value *RHS;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00001866 explicit AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001867 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1868 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001869 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00001870 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001871 }
1872};
1873
1874// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1875// iff C1&C2 == 0
1876struct AddMaskingAnd {
1877 Constant *C2;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00001878 explicit AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001879 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001880 ConstantInt *C1;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00001881 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00001882 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001883 }
1884 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001885 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001886 }
1887};
1888
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001889}
1890
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001891static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001892 InstCombiner *IC) {
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00001893 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I))
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00001894 return IC->Builder->CreateCast(CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType());
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001895
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001896 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001897 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1898 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001899
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001900 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1901 if (ConstIsRHS)
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00001902 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1903 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001904 }
1905
1906 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1907 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1908 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00001909
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001910 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00001911 return IC->Builder->CreateBinOp(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,
1912 SO->getName()+".op");
1913 if (ICmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(&I))
1914 return IC->Builder->CreateICmp(CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
1915 SO->getName()+".cmp");
1916 if (FCmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(&I))
1917 return IC->Builder->CreateICmp(CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
1918 SO->getName()+".cmp");
1919 llvm_unreachable("Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001920}
1921
1922// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1923// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1924// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1925// not have a second operand.
1926static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1927 InstCombiner *IC) {
1928 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1929 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1930 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1931 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1932
1933 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001934 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00001935 if (SI->getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*IC->getContext())) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001936
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001937 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1938 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1939
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001940 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1941 SelectFalseVal);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001942 }
1943 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001944}
1945
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001946
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00001947/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator, cast instruction, or select which
1948/// has a PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the
1949/// PHI (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00001950///
1951/// If AllowAggressive is true, FoldOpIntoPhi will allow certain transforms
1952/// that would normally be unprofitable because they strongly encourage jump
1953/// threading.
1954Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I,
1955 bool AllowAggressive) {
1956 AllowAggressive = false;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001957 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001958 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00001959 if (NumPHIValues == 0 ||
1960 // We normally only transform phis with a single use, unless we're trying
1961 // hard to make jump threading happen.
1962 (!PN->hasOneUse() && !AllowAggressive))
1963 return 0;
1964
1965
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00001966 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are simple constants
1967 // (constantint/constantfp/undef). If there is one non-constant value,
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00001968 // remember the BB it is in. If there is more than one or if *it* is a PHI,
1969 // bail out. We don't do arbitrary constant expressions here because moving
1970 // their computation can be expensive without a cost model.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001971 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1972 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00001973 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i)) ||
1974 isa<ConstantExpr>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001975 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001976 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001977 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1978
1979 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1980 // loop.
1981 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1982 return 0;
1983 }
1984
1985 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1986 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1987 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1988 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00001989 if (NonConstBB != 0 && !AllowAggressive) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001990 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1991 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1992 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001993
1994 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001995 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001996 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001997 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001998 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001999
2000 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002001 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(&I)) {
2002 // We only currently try to fold the condition of a select when it is a phi,
2003 // not the true/false values.
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002004 Value *TrueV = SI->getTrueValue();
2005 Value *FalseV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner3ddfb212009-09-28 06:49:44 +00002006 BasicBlock *PhiTransBB = PN->getParent();
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002007 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002008 BasicBlock *ThisBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
Chris Lattner3ddfb212009-09-28 06:49:44 +00002009 Value *TrueVInPred = TrueV->DoPHITranslation(PhiTransBB, ThisBB);
2010 Value *FalseVInPred = FalseV->DoPHITranslation(PhiTransBB, ThisBB);
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002011 Value *InV = 0;
2012 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002013 InV = InC->isNullValue() ? FalseVInPred : TrueVInPred;
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002014 } else {
2015 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002016 InV = SelectInst::Create(PN->getIncomingValue(i), TrueVInPred,
2017 FalseVInPred,
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002018 "phitmp", NonConstBB->getTerminator());
2019 Worklist.Add(cast<Instruction>(InV));
2020 }
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00002021 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, ThisBB);
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00002022 }
2023 } else if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002024 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00002025 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00002026 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002027 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002028 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002029 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002030 else
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002031 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002032 } else {
2033 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
2034 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002035 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002036 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
2037 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002038 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00002039 InV = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002040 CI->getPredicate(),
2041 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
2042 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002043 else
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00002044 llvm_unreachable("Unknown binop!");
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002045
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00002046 Worklist.Add(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002047 }
2048 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002049 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002050 } else {
2051 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
2052 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00002053 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002054 Value *InV;
2055 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002056 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002057 } else {
2058 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002059 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002060 I.getType(), "phitmp",
2061 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00002062 Worklist.Add(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002063 }
2064 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002065 }
2066 }
2067 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
2068}
2069
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002070
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002071/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
2072/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
2073/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
2074/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
2075bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
2076 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
2077 // ones.
2078
2079 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
2080 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
2081 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values will
2082 // sign extend fine.
2083 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
2084 return true;
2085
2086
2087 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
2088 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
2089 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
2090 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
2091
2092 // TODO: Implement.
2093
2094 return false;
2095}
2096
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002097
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002098Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002099 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002100 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002101
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002102 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002103 // X + undef -> undef
2104 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
2105 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
2106
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002107 // X + 0 --> X
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002108 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
2109 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002110
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002111 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002112 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002113 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002114 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002115 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002116 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002117
2118 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
2119 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00002120 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00002121 return &I;
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00002122
Eli Friedman709b33d2009-07-13 22:27:52 +00002123 // zext(bool) + C -> bool ? C + 1 : C
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00002124 if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(LHS))
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002125 if (ZI->getSrcTy() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002126 return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0), AddOne(CI), CI);
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002127 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002128
2129 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2130 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2131 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002132
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002133 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
2134 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00002135 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002136 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00002137 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002138 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002139
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002140 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002141 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
2142 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002143 do {
2144 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002145 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
2146 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002147 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
2148 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002149 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002150 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
2151 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002152 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002153 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002154 }
2155 }
2156 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002157 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2158 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2159 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002160
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002161 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00002162 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
2163 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
2164 // that the back ends can handle.
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002165 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2166 switch (Size) {
2167 default: break;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002168 case 32: MiddleType = Type::getInt32Ty(*Context); break;
2169 case 16: MiddleType = Type::getInt16Ty(*Context); break;
2170 case 8: MiddleType = Type::getInt8Ty(*Context); break;
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002171 }
2172 if (MiddleType) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002173 Value *NewTrunc = Builder->CreateTrunc(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002174 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002175 }
2176 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002177 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002178
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002179 if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002180 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
2181
Nick Lewycky7d26bd82008-05-23 04:39:38 +00002182 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002183 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002184 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS)))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002185 return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002186
2187 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2188 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2189 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2190 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2191 }
2192 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2193 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2194 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2195 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2196 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002197 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002198
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002199 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002200 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002201 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS)) {
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002202 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002203 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002204 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002205 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(NewAdd);
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002206 }
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002207 }
2208
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002209 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002210 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002211
2212 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002213 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002214 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002215 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002216
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002217
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002218 ConstantInt *C2;
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002219 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002220 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002221 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002222
2223 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2224 ConstantInt *C1;
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002225 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002226 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, ConstantExpr::getAdd(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002227 }
2228
2229 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002230 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
2231 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002232
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002233 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002234 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS ||
2235 dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00002236 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002237
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002238
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002239 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002240 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
2241 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002242 return R;
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002243
2244 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2245 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2246 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2247 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2248 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2249 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2250 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2251 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2252 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2253 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2254
2255 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner9d60ba92008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002256 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002257 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002258 }
2259 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002260
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002261 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky0c2c3f62008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002262 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002263 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002264 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X))) &&
2265 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)))) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002266 if (W != Y) {
2267 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002268 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002269 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002270 std::swap(W, X);
2271 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002272 std::swap(Y, Z);
2273 std::swap(W, X);
2274 }
2275 }
2276
2277 if (W == Y) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002278 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(X, Z, LHS->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002279 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002280 }
2281 }
2282 }
2283
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002284 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002285 Value *X = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002286 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002287 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002288
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002289 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002290 if (LHS->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002291 match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002292 Constant *Anded = ConstantExpr::getAnd(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002293 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2294 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2295 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002296 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002297
2298 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002299 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002300
2301 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002302 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002303
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002304 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2305 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002306 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(X, CRHS, LHS->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002307 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002308 }
2309 }
2310 }
2311
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002312 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2313 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002314 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002315 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002316 }
2317
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002318 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002319 {
2320 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002321 Value *A = RHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002322 if (!SI) {
2323 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002324 A = LHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002325 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002326 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002327 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2328 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002329 Value *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002330
2331 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2332 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002333 if (match(FV, m_Zero()) &&
2334 match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A))))
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002335 // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002336 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002337 if (match(TV, m_Zero()) &&
2338 match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A))))
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002339 // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002340 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002341 }
2342 }
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002343
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002344 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2345 // integer add followed by a sext.
2346 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2347 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2348 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2349 Constant *CI =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002350 ConstantExpr::getTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002351 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002352 ConstantExpr::getSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002353 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2354 // Insert the new, smaller add.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002355 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2356 CI, "addconv");
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002357 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2358 }
2359 }
2360
2361 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2362 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2363 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2364 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2365 // integer add will not overflow.
2366 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2367 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2368 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2369 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2370 // Insert the new integer add.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002371 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2372 RHSConv->getOperand(0), "addconv");
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002373 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2374 }
2375 }
2376 }
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002377
2378 return Changed ? &I : 0;
2379}
2380
2381Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
2382 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
2383 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
2384
2385 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
2386 // X + 0 --> X
2387 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Owen Anderson6f83c9c2009-07-27 20:59:43 +00002388 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002389 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
2390 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
2391 }
2392
2393 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2394 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2395 return NV;
2396 }
2397
2398 // -A + B --> B - A
2399 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002400 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castFNegVal(LHS))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002401 return BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(RHS, LHSV);
2402
2403 // A + -B --> A - B
2404 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002405 if (Value *V = dyn_castFNegVal(RHS))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002406 return BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(LHS, V);
2407
2408 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2409 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2410 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2411 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
2412
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002413 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2414 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2415 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2416 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2417 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2418 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2419 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2420 // instcombined.
2421 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2422 Constant *CI =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002423 ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002424 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002425 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002426 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2427 // Insert the new integer add.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002428 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2429 CI, "addconv");
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002430 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2431 }
2432 }
2433
2434 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2435 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2436 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2437 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2438 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2439 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2440 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2441 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2442 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2443 // Insert the new integer add.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002444 Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2445 RHSConv->getOperand(0), "addconv");
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002446 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2447 }
2448 }
2449 }
2450
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002451 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002452}
2453
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002454Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002455 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002456
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002457 if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00002458 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002459
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002460 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002461 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002462 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002463
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002464 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2465 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2466 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2467 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2468
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002469 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2470 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002471 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002472 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002473
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002474 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002475 Value *X = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002476 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002477 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C));
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002478
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002479 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2480 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002481 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002482 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002483 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002484 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002485 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002486 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002487 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002488 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002489 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002490 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002491 }
2492 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002493 }
2494 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2495 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2496 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002497 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002498 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002499 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002500 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002501 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002502 }
2503 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002504 }
2505 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002506 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002507
2508 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2509 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002510 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002511 return R;
Eli Friedman709b33d2009-07-13 22:27:52 +00002512
2513 // C - zext(bool) -> bool ? C - 1 : C
2514 if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op1))
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002515 if (ZI->getSrcTy() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002516 return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0), SubOne(C), C);
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002517 }
2518
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002519 if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002520 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2521
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002522 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002523 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002524 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002525 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002526 I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002527 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002528 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002529 I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002530 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2531 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2532 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002533 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002534 ConstantExpr::getSub(CI1, CI2), Op1I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002535 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002536 }
2537
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002538 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002539 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2540 // is not used by anyone else...
2541 //
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002542 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002543 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2544 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2545 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2546 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002547
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002548 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002549 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002550 }
2551
2552 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2553 //
2554 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2555 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2556 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2557
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002558 Value *NewNot = Builder->CreateNot(OtherOp, "B.not");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002559 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002560 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002561
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002562 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002563 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002564 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002565 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002566 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002567 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002568 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002569
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002570 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002571 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002572 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002573 Constant *CP1 =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002574 ConstantExpr::getSub(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00002575 C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002576 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002577 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002578 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002579 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002580
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002581 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
2582 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
2583 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2584 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2585 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2586 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
2587 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2588 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002589 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002590 I.getName());
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002591 }
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002592 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002593
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002594 ConstantInt *C1;
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002595 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002596 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002597 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002598
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002599 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002600 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002601 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, ConstantExpr::getSub(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002602 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002603 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002604}
2605
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002606Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
2607 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2608
2609 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002610 if (Value *V = dyn_castFNegVal(Op1))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002611 return BinaryOperator::CreateFAdd(Op0, V);
2612
2613 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2614 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd) {
2615 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002616 return BinaryOperator::CreateFNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002617 I.getName());
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002618 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002619 return BinaryOperator::CreateFNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002620 I.getName());
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002621 }
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002622 }
2623
2624 return 0;
2625}
2626
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002627/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2628/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2629/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2630/// signed.
2631static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2632 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002633 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002634 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2635 TrueIfSigned = true;
2636 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002637 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2638 TrueIfSigned = true;
2639 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002640 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2641 TrueIfSigned = false;
2642 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002643 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2644 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2645 TrueIfSigned = true;
2646 return RHS->getValue() ==
2647 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2648 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2649 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2650 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00002651 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002652 default:
2653 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002654 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002655}
2656
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002657Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002658 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002659 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002660
Eli Friedman1694e092009-07-18 09:12:15 +00002661 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00002662 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002663
Chris Lattner8af304a2009-10-11 07:53:15 +00002664 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS.
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002665 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2666 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002667
2668 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002669 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002670 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2671 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002672 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002673 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002674
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002675 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002676 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2677 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2678 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2679 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002680 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002681
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002682 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002683 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002684 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00002685 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002686 }
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +00002687 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1->getType())) {
Eli Friedmanb4687092009-07-14 02:01:53 +00002688 if (Op1->isNullValue())
2689 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00002690
2691 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
2692 if (Op1V->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00002693 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00002694
2695 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2696 if (Constant *Splat = Op1V->getSplatValue()) {
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00002697 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Splat))
2698 if (CI->equalsInt(1))
2699 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2700 }
2701 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002702 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002703
2704 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2705 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattner47c99092008-05-18 04:11:26 +00002706 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002707 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002708 Value *Add = Builder->CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op1, "tmp");
2709 Value *C1C2 = Builder->CreateMul(Op1, Op0I->getOperand(1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002710 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002711
2712 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002713
2714 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2715 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002716 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002717 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002718
2719 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2720 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2721 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002722 }
2723
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002724 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2725 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002726 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002727
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002728 // (X / Y) * Y = X - (X % Y)
2729 // (X / Y) * -Y = (X % Y) - X
2730 {
2731 Value *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2732 BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
2733 if (!BO ||
2734 (BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::UDiv &&
2735 BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::SDiv)) {
2736 Op1 = Op0;
2737 BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1));
2738 }
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002739 Value *Neg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002740 if (BO && BO->hasOneUse() &&
2741 (BO->getOperand(1) == Op1 || BO->getOperand(1) == Neg) &&
2742 (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv ||
2743 BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)) {
2744 Value *Op0BO = BO->getOperand(0), *Op1BO = BO->getOperand(1);
2745
Dan Gohmanfa94b942009-08-12 16:33:09 +00002746 // If the division is exact, X % Y is zero.
2747 if (SDivOperator *SDiv = dyn_cast<SDivOperator>(BO))
2748 if (SDiv->isExact()) {
2749 if (Op1BO == Op1)
2750 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0BO);
2751 else
2752 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0BO);
2753 }
2754
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002755 Value *Rem;
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002756 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002757 Rem = Builder->CreateURem(Op0BO, Op1BO);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002758 else
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002759 Rem = Builder->CreateSRem(Op0BO, Op1BO);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002760 Rem->takeName(BO);
2761
2762 if (Op1BO == Op1)
2763 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Op0BO, Rem);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002764 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Rem, Op0BO);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002765 }
2766 }
2767
Chris Lattner8af304a2009-10-11 07:53:15 +00002768 /// i1 mul -> i1 and.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002769 if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002770 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
2771
Chris Lattner8af304a2009-10-11 07:53:15 +00002772 // X*(1 << Y) --> X << Y
2773 // (1 << Y)*X --> X << Y
2774 {
2775 Value *Y;
2776 if (match(Op0, m_Shl(m_One(), m_Value(Y))))
2777 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I.getOperand(1), Y);
2778 if (match(I.getOperand(1), m_Shl(m_One(), m_Value(Y))))
2779 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0, Y);
2780 }
2781
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002782 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2783 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2784 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2785 // formed.
2786 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002787 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op0))
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002788 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002789 BoolCast = CI;
2790 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002791 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00002792 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002793 BoolCast = CI;
2794 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002795 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002796 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2797 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002798 bool TIS = false;
2799
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002800 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002801 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2802 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002803 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2804 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002805 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00002806 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002807 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00002808 Value *V = Builder->CreateAShr(SCIOp0, Amt,
2809 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+".mask");
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002810
2811 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2812 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00002813 if (I.getType() != V->getType())
2814 V = Builder->CreateIntCast(V, I.getType(), true);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002815
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002816 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002817 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002818 }
2819 }
2820 }
2821
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002822 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002823}
2824
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002825Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
2826 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
2827 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
2828
2829 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
2830 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2831 if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
2832 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2833 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
2834 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2835 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2836 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1->getType())) {
2837 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
2838 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2839 if (Constant *Splat = Op1V->getSplatValue()) {
2840 if (ConstantFP *F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Splat))
2841 if (F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2842 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2843 }
2844 }
2845 }
2846
2847 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2848 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2849 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2850 return R;
2851
2852 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2853 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2854 return NV;
2855 }
2856
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002857 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castFNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2858 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castFNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002859 return BinaryOperator::CreateFMul(Op0v, Op1v);
2860
2861 return Changed ? &I : 0;
2862}
2863
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002864/// SimplifyDivRemOfSelect - Try to fold a divide or remainder of a select
2865/// instruction.
2866bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I) {
2867 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I.getOperand(1));
2868
2869 // div/rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div/rem X, Y
2870 int NonNullOperand = -1;
2871 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2872 if (ST->isNullValue())
2873 NonNullOperand = 2;
2874 // div/rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div/rem X, Y
2875 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2876 if (ST->isNullValue())
2877 NonNullOperand = 1;
2878
2879 if (NonNullOperand == -1)
2880 return false;
2881
2882 Value *SelectCond = SI->getOperand(0);
2883
2884 // Change the div/rem to use 'Y' instead of the select.
2885 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand));
2886
2887 // Okay, we know we replace the operand of the div/rem with 'Y' with no
2888 // problem. However, the select, or the condition of the select may have
2889 // multiple uses. Based on our knowledge that the operand must be non-zero,
2890 // propagate the known value for the select into other uses of it, and
2891 // propagate a known value of the condition into its other users.
2892
2893 // If the select and condition only have a single use, don't bother with this,
2894 // early exit.
2895 if (SI->use_empty() && SelectCond->hasOneUse())
2896 return true;
2897
2898 // Scan the current block backward, looking for other uses of SI.
2899 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &I, BBFront = I.getParent()->begin();
2900
2901 while (BBI != BBFront) {
2902 --BBI;
2903 // If we found a call to a function, we can't assume it will return, so
2904 // information from below it cannot be propagated above it.
2905 if (isa<CallInst>(BBI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BBI))
2906 break;
2907
2908 // Replace uses of the select or its condition with the known values.
2909 for (Instruction::op_iterator I = BBI->op_begin(), E = BBI->op_end();
2910 I != E; ++I) {
2911 if (*I == SI) {
2912 *I = SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00002913 Worklist.Add(BBI);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002914 } else if (*I == SelectCond) {
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00002915 *I = NonNullOperand == 1 ? ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context) :
2916 ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00002917 Worklist.Add(BBI);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002918 }
2919 }
2920
2921 // If we past the instruction, quit looking for it.
2922 if (&*BBI == SI)
2923 SI = 0;
2924 if (&*BBI == SelectCond)
2925 SelectCond = 0;
2926
2927 // If we ran out of things to eliminate, break out of the loop.
2928 if (SelectCond == 0 && SI == 0)
2929 break;
2930
2931 }
2932 return true;
2933}
2934
2935
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002936/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2937/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2938/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2939/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002940Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002941 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002942
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002943 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
2944 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
2945 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
2946 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2947 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00002948 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002949 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002950
2951 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002952 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002953 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002954
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002955 return 0;
2956}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002957
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002958/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2959/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2960/// division instructions.
2961/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002962Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002963 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2964
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002965 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002966 if (Op0 == Op1) {
2967 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00002968 Constant *CI = ConstantInt::get(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002969 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00002970 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002971 }
2972
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00002973 Constant *CI = ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1);
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002974 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
2975 }
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002976
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002977 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2978 return Common;
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002979
2980 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2981 // This does not apply for fdiv.
2982 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2983 return &I;
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002984
2985 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2986 // div X, 1 == X
2987 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2988 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2989
2990 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2991 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2992 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2993 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002994 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00002995 I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00002996 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002997 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002998 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00002999 ConstantExpr::getMul(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00003000 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003001
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003002 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003003 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
3004 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
3005 return R;
3006 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3007 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3008 return NV;
3009 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00003010 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003011
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003012 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00003013 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003014 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003015 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003016
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00003017 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00003018 if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00003019 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3020
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00003021 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3022 if (ConstantInt *X = cast_or_null<ConstantInt>(Op1V->getSplatValue()))
3023 // div X, 1 == X
3024 if (X->isOne())
3025 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3026 }
3027
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003028 return 0;
3029}
3030
3031Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
3032 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3033
3034 // Handle the integer div common cases
3035 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
3036 return Common;
3037
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003038 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003039 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
3040 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
3041 // if so, convert to a right shift.
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003042 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003043 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003044 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003045
3046 // X udiv C, where C >= signbit
3047 if (C->getValue().isNegative()) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003048 Value *IC = Builder->CreateICmpULT( Op0, C);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003049 return SelectInst::Create(IC, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003050 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003051 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003052 }
3053
3054 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003055 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003056 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3057 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003058 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003059 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003060 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003061 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003062 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2())
3063 N = Builder->CreateAdd(N, ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2), "tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003064 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003065 }
3066 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00003067 }
3068
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003069 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
3070 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003071 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003072 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003073 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003074 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003075 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003076 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003077 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003078 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003079 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003080 Value *TSI = Builder->CreateLShr(Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003081
3082 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003083 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003084 Value *FSI = Builder->CreateLShr(Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003085
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003086 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003087 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003088 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003089 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003090 return 0;
3091}
3092
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003093Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
3094 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3095
3096 // Handle the integer div common cases
3097 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
3098 return Common;
3099
3100 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3101 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
3102 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00003103 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0);
Dan Gohman1bdf5dc2009-08-11 20:47:47 +00003104
Dan Gohmanfa94b942009-08-12 16:33:09 +00003105 // sdiv X, C --> ashr X, log2(C)
Dan Gohman1bdf5dc2009-08-11 20:47:47 +00003106 if (cast<SDivOperator>(&I)->isExact() &&
3107 RHS->getValue().isNonNegative() &&
3108 RHS->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3109 Value *ShAmt = llvm::ConstantInt::get(RHS->getType(),
3110 RHS->getValue().exactLogBase2());
3111 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(Op0, ShAmt, I.getName());
3112 }
Dan Gohman9ca9daa2009-08-12 16:37:02 +00003113
3114 // -X/C --> X/-C provided the negation doesn't overflow.
3115 if (SubOperator *Sub = dyn_cast<SubOperator>(Op0))
3116 if (isa<Constant>(Sub->getOperand(0)) &&
3117 cast<Constant>(Sub->getOperand(0))->isNullValue() &&
Dan Gohman5078f842009-08-20 17:11:38 +00003118 Sub->hasNoSignedWrap())
Dan Gohman9ca9daa2009-08-12 16:37:02 +00003119 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Sub->getOperand(1),
3120 ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003121 }
3122
3123 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
3124 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003125 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003126 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Eli Friedman8be17392009-07-18 09:53:21 +00003127 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3128 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask)) {
3129 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
3130 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
3131 }
3132 ConstantInt *ShiftedInt;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00003133 if (match(Op1, m_Shl(m_ConstantInt(ShiftedInt), m_Value())) &&
Eli Friedman8be17392009-07-18 09:53:21 +00003134 ShiftedInt->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3135 // X sdiv (1 << Y) -> X udiv (1 << Y) ( -> X u>> Y)
3136 // Safe because the only negative value (1 << Y) can take on is
3137 // INT_MIN, and X sdiv INT_MIN == X udiv INT_MIN == 0 if X doesn't have
3138 // the sign bit set.
3139 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
3140 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003141 }
Eli Friedman8be17392009-07-18 09:53:21 +00003142 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003143
3144 return 0;
3145}
3146
3147Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
3148 return commonDivTransforms(I);
3149}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003150
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003151/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
3152/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
3153/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
3154/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
3155Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00003156 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003157
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00003158 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
3159 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
3160 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003161 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00003162 }
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00003163 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
3164 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003165
3166 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00003167 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
3168 return &I;
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00003169
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003170 return 0;
3171}
3172
3173/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
3174/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
3175/// remainder instructions.
3176/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
3177Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
3178 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3179
3180 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
3181 return common;
3182
Dale Johannesened6af242009-01-21 00:35:19 +00003183 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
3184 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
3185 if (LHS->isNullValue())
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003186 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Dale Johannesened6af242009-01-21 00:35:19 +00003187
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00003188 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00003189 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
3190 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00003191 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00003192
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003193 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003194 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003195
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003196 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
3197 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
3198 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
3199 return R;
3200 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
3201 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3202 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003203 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00003204
3205 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00003206 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00003207 return &I;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003208 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003209 }
3210
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003211 return 0;
3212}
3213
3214Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3215 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3216
3217 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3218 return common;
3219
3220 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3221 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
3222 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
3223 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
3224 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003225 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003226 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003227 }
3228
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003229 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003230 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
3231 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3232 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00003233 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00003234 Constant *N1 = Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003235 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(RHSI, N1, "tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003236 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003237 }
3238 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003239 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00003240
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003241 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
3242 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
3243 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
3244 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
3245 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
3246 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003247 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
3248 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003249 Value *TrueAnd = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO),
3250 SI->getName()+".t");
3251 Value *FalseAnd = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO),
3252 SI->getName()+".f");
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003253 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003254 }
3255 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003256 }
3257
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003258 return 0;
3259}
3260
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003261Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3262 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3263
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003264 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +00003265 if (Instruction *Common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3266 return Common;
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003267
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003268 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00003269 if (!isa<Constant>(RHSNeg) ||
3270 (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) &&
3271 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003272 // X % -Y -> X % Y
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +00003273 Worklist.AddValue(I.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003274 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
3275 return &I;
3276 }
Nick Lewyckya06cf822008-09-30 06:08:34 +00003277
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003278 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003279 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003280 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
3281 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
3282 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3283 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003284 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003285 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003286 }
3287
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003288 // If it's a constant vector, flip any negative values positive.
Nick Lewycky9dce8732008-12-20 16:48:00 +00003289 if (ConstantVector *RHSV = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3290 unsigned VWidth = RHSV->getNumOperands();
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003291
Nick Lewycky9dce8732008-12-20 16:48:00 +00003292 bool hasNegative = false;
3293 for (unsigned i = 0; !hasNegative && i != VWidth; ++i)
3294 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSV->getOperand(i)))
3295 if (RHS->getValue().isNegative())
3296 hasNegative = true;
3297
3298 if (hasNegative) {
3299 std::vector<Constant *> Elts(VWidth);
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003300 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i) {
3301 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSV->getOperand(i))) {
3302 if (RHS->getValue().isNegative())
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003303 Elts[i] = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003304 else
3305 Elts[i] = RHS;
3306 }
3307 }
3308
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +00003309 Constant *NewRHSV = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003310 if (NewRHSV != RHSV) {
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +00003311 Worklist.AddValue(I.getOperand(1));
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003312 I.setOperand(1, NewRHSV);
3313 return &I;
3314 }
3315 }
3316 }
3317
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003318 return 0;
3319}
3320
3321Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003322 return commonRemTransforms(I);
3323}
3324
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003325// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
3326// constant.
3327static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00003328 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003329}
3330
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003331// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
3332// This is the same as lowones(~X).
3333static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00003334 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003335}
3336
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003337/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003338/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
3339///
3340/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
3341///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003342/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
3343/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003344///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003345/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
3346/// 0 A > B
3347/// 1 A == B
3348/// 2 A < B
3349///
3350/// <=> Value Definition
3351/// 000 0 Always false
3352/// 001 1 A > B
3353/// 010 2 A == B
3354/// 011 3 A >= B
3355/// 100 4 A < B
3356/// 101 5 A != B
3357/// 110 6 A <= B
3358/// 111 7 Always true
3359///
3360static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3361 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003362 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003363 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3364 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3365 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3366 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3367 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3368 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3369 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3370 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3371 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3372 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003373 // True -> 7
3374 default:
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003375 llvm_unreachable("Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003376 return 0;
3377 }
3378}
3379
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003380/// getFCmpCode - Similar to getICmpCode but for FCmpInst. This encodes a fcmp
3381/// predicate into a three bit mask. It also returns whether it is an ordered
3382/// predicate by reference.
3383static unsigned getFCmpCode(FCmpInst::Predicate CC, bool &isOrdered) {
3384 isOrdered = false;
3385 switch (CC) {
3386 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: isOrdered = true; return 0; // 000
3387 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: return 0; // 000
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003388 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: isOrdered = true; return 1; // 001
3389 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3390 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: isOrdered = true; return 2; // 010
3391 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: return 2; // 010
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003392 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: isOrdered = true; return 3; // 011
3393 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3394 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: isOrdered = true; return 4; // 100
3395 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003396 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: isOrdered = true; return 5; // 101
3397 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: return 5; // 101
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003398 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: isOrdered = true; return 6; // 110
3399 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003400 // True -> 7
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003401 default:
3402 // Not expecting FCMP_FALSE and FCMP_TRUE;
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003403 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected FCmp predicate!");
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003404 return 0;
3405 }
3406}
3407
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003408/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3409/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003410/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003411/// of predicate to use in the new icmp instruction.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003412static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00003413 LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003414 switch (code) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003415 default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal ICmp code!");
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003416 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003417 case 1:
3418 if (sign)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003419 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003420 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003421 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3422 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003423 case 3:
3424 if (sign)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003425 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003426 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003427 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003428 case 4:
3429 if (sign)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003430 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003431 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003432 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3433 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003434 case 6:
3435 if (sign)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003436 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003437 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003438 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003439 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003440 }
3441}
3442
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003443/// getFCmpValue - This is the complement of getFCmpCode, which turns an
3444/// opcode and two operands into either a FCmp instruction. isordered is passed
3445/// in to determine which kind of predicate to use in the new fcmp instruction.
3446static Value *getFCmpValue(bool isordered, unsigned code,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00003447 Value *LHS, Value *RHS, LLVMContext *Context) {
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003448 switch (code) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003449 default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal FCmp code!");
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003450 case 0:
3451 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003452 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003453 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003454 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003455 case 1:
3456 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003457 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003458 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003459 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003460 case 2:
3461 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003462 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003463 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003464 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003465 case 3:
3466 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003467 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003468 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003469 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003470 case 4:
3471 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003472 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003473 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003474 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003475 case 5:
3476 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003477 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003478 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003479 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003480 case 6:
3481 if (isordered)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003482 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003483 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003484 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003485 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003486 }
3487}
3488
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003489/// PredicatesFoldable - Return true if both predicates match sign or if at
3490/// least one of them is an equality comparison (which is signless).
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003491static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
3492 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003493 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p2)) ||
3494 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003495}
3496
3497namespace {
3498// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3499struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003500 InstCombiner &IC;
3501 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003502 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3503 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3504 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3505 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003506 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003507 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3508 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003509 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3510 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003511 return false;
3512 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003513 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3514 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3515 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3516 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3517 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003518 }
3519
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003520 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003521 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003522 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003523 unsigned Code;
3524 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3525 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3526 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3527 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003528 default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003529 }
3530
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003531 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3532 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3533
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003534 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS, IC.getContext());
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003535 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3536 return I;
3537 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3538 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3539 }
3540};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003541} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003542
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003543// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3544// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003545// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003546Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003547 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3548 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003549 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3550 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003551 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003552 if (!Op->isShift())
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003553 Together = ConstantExpr::getAnd(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003554
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003555 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3556 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003557 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003558 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003559 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003560 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003561 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003562 }
3563 break;
3564 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003565 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3566 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003567
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003568 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3569 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003570 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003571 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003572 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003573 }
3574 break;
3575 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003576 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003577 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3578 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3579 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003580 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003581
3582 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003583 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003584 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3585 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3586 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003587 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003588
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003589 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3590 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3591 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3592 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3593 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3594 // no effect.
3595 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3596 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3597 return &TheAnd;
3598 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003599 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003600 Value *NewAnd = Builder->CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003601 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003602 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003603 }
3604 }
3605 }
3606 }
3607 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003608
3609 case Instruction::Shl: {
3610 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3611 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3612 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003613 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003614 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003615 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003616 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(*Context, AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003617
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003618 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3619 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003620 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3621 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003622 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3623 return &TheAnd;
3624 }
3625 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003626 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003627 case Instruction::LShr:
3628 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003629 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3630 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3631 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3632 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003633 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003634 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003635 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003636 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(*Context, AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003637
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003638 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3639 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003640 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3641 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3642 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3643 return &TheAnd;
3644 }
3645 break;
3646 }
3647 case Instruction::AShr:
3648 // Signed shr.
3649 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3650 // with an and.
3651 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003652 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003653 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003654 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003655 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(*Context, AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003656 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003657 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003658 // Make the argument unsigned.
3659 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003660 ShVal = Builder->CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS, Op->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003661 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003662 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003663 }
3664 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003665 }
3666 return 0;
3667}
3668
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003669
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003670/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3671/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003672/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3673/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003674/// insert new instructions.
3675Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003676 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3677 Instruction &IB) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003678 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003679 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003680 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003681
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003682 if (Inside) {
3683 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003684 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003685
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003686 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003687 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003688 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003689 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003690 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003691 }
3692
3693 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003694 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003695 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003696 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003697 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003698 }
3699
3700 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003701 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003702
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003703 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003704 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003705 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003706 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3707 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003708 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003709 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003710
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003711 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3712 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003713 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003714 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003715 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003716 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003717}
3718
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003719// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3720// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3721// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3722// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003723static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003724 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003725 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3726 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003727
3728 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003729 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003730 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003731 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003732 return true;
3733}
3734
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003735/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3736/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3737/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003738///
3739/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3740/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3741/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3742///
3743/// return (A +/- B).
3744///
3745Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003746 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003747 Instruction &I) {
3748 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3749 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3750 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3751
3752 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3753
3754 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3755 default: return 0;
3756 case Instruction::And:
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003757 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003758 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003759 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3760 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3761 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003762 break;
3763
3764 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3765 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3766 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003767 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003768 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003769 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003770 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003771 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003772 break;
3773 }
3774 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003775 return 0;
3776 case Instruction::Or:
3777 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003778 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003779 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3780 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003781 && ConstantExpr::getAnd(N, Mask)->isNullValue())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003782 break;
3783 return 0;
3784 }
3785
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003786 if (isSub)
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003787 return Builder->CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3788 return Builder->CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003789}
3790
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003791/// FoldAndOfICmps - Fold (icmp)&(icmp) if possible.
3792Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldAndOfICmps(Instruction &I,
3793 ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS) {
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003794 Value *Val, *Val2;
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003795 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
3796 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3797
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003798 // This only handles icmp of constants: (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 B, C2).
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00003799 if (!match(LHS, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00003800 m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))) ||
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00003801 !match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(Val2),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00003802 m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003803 return 0;
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003804
3805 // (icmp ult A, C) & (icmp ult B, C) --> (icmp ult (A|B), C)
3806 // where C is a power of 2
3807 if (LHSCst == RHSCst && LHSCC == RHSCC && LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
3808 LHSCst->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003809 Value *NewOr = Builder->CreateOr(Val, Val2);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003810 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, LHSCst);
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003811 }
3812
3813 // From here on, we only handle:
3814 // (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
3815 if (Val != Val2) return 0;
3816
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003817 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
3818 if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
3819 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
3820 LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE ||
3821 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
3822 return 0;
3823
3824 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) & (sgt x, C2).
3825 if (!PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC))
3826 return 0;
3827
3828 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003829 bool ShouldSwap;
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003830 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
3831 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
3832 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003833 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003834 else
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003835 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
3836
3837 if (ShouldSwap) {
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003838 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3839 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3840 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3841 }
3842
3843 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
3844 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3845 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
3846 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3847 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3848 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
3849 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3850
3851 switch (LHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003852 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003853 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
3854 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003855 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003856 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3857 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3858 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003859 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003860 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3861 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3862 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3863 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3864 }
3865 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3866 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003867 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003868 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003869 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003870 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Val, LHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003871 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3872 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003873 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003874 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Val, LHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003875 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3876 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3877 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3878 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3879 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3880 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003881 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00003882 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00003883 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(Val, AddCST, Val->getName()+".off");
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003884 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00003885 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003886 }
3887 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3888 }
3889 break;
3890 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3891 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003892 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003893 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3894 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003895 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003896 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3897 break;
3898 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3899 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
3900 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3901 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3902 break;
3903 }
3904 break;
3905 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3906 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003907 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003908 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3909 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003910 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003911 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3912 break;
3913 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3914 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
3915 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3916 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3917 break;
3918 }
3919 break;
3920 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3921 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003922 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003923 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3924 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3925 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3926 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3927 break;
3928 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003929 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003930 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003931 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00003932 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) -> (X-14) <u 1
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003933 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003934 RHSCst, false, true, I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003935 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3936 break;
3937 }
3938 break;
3939 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3940 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003941 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003942 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3943 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3944 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3945 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3946 break;
3947 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003948 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003949 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003950 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00003951 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) -> (X-14) s< 1
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00003952 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003953 RHSCst, true, true, I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003954 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3955 break;
3956 }
3957 break;
3958 }
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003959
3960 return 0;
3961}
3962
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00003963Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldAndOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS,
3964 FCmpInst *RHS) {
3965
3966 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
3967 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD) {
3968 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
3969 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
3970 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
3971 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
3972 // false.
3973 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00003974 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003975 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD,
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00003976 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
3977 }
Chris Lattnerf98d2532009-07-23 05:32:17 +00003978
3979 // Handle vector zeros. This occurs because the canonical form of
3980 // "fcmp ord x,x" is "fcmp ord x, 0".
3981 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(LHS->getOperand(1)) &&
3982 isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(RHS->getOperand(1)))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00003983 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD,
Chris Lattnerf98d2532009-07-23 05:32:17 +00003984 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00003985 return 0;
3986 }
3987
3988 Value *Op0LHS = LHS->getOperand(0), *Op0RHS = LHS->getOperand(1);
3989 Value *Op1LHS = RHS->getOperand(0), *Op1RHS = RHS->getOperand(1);
3990 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC = LHS->getPredicate(), Op1CC = RHS->getPredicate();
3991
3992
3993 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
3994 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
3995 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
3996 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
3997 }
3998
3999 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4000 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) & (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4001 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004002 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00004003
4004 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE || Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004005 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00004006 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4007 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4008 if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4009 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4010
4011 bool Op0Ordered;
4012 bool Op1Ordered;
4013 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4014 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4015 if (Op1Pred == 0) {
4016 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4017 std::swap(Op0Pred, Op1Pred);
4018 std::swap(Op0Ordered, Op1Ordered);
4019 }
4020 if (Op0Pred == 0) {
4021 // uno && ueq -> uno && (uno || eq) -> ueq
4022 // ord && olt -> ord && (ord && lt) -> olt
4023 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered)
4024 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4025
4026 // uno && oeq -> uno && (ord && eq) -> false
4027 // uno && ord -> false
4028 if (!Op0Ordered)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004029 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00004030 // ord && ueq -> ord && (uno || eq) -> oeq
4031 return cast<Instruction>(getFCmpValue(true, Op1Pred,
4032 Op0LHS, Op0RHS, Context));
4033 }
4034 }
4035
4036 return 0;
4037}
4038
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004039
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004040Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004041 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004042 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004043
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004044 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00004045 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004046
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004047 // and X, X = X
4048 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004049 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004050
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004051 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00004052 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00004053 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
4054 return &I;
4055 if (isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00004056 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004057 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00004058 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004059 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4060 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00004061 }
4062 }
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00004063
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004064 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00004065 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
4066 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004067
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00004068 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004069 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00004070 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004071 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
4072 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
4073 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
4074 case Instruction::Xor:
4075 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004076 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
4077 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4078 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
4079 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004080 Value *NewRHS = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
4081 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004082 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004083 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004084 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00004085 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004086 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
4087 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004088 Value *NewLHS = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
4089 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004090 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004091 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
4092 }
4093 }
4094
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004095 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004096 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004097 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
4098 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4099 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4100 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004101 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004102 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004103 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004104 break;
4105
4106 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004107 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
4108 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4109 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4110 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004111 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004112
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00004113 // (A - N) & AndRHS -> -N & AndRHS iff A&AndRHS==0 and AndRHS
4114 // has 1's for all bits that the subtraction with A might affect.
4115 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4116 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHSMask.getBitWidth();
4117 uint32_t Zeros = AndRHSMask.countLeadingZeros();
4118 APInt Mask = APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - Zeros);
4119
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004120 ConstantInt *A = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0LHS);
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00004121 if (!(A && A->isZero()) && // avoid infinite recursion.
4122 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004123 Value *NewNeg = Builder->CreateNeg(Op0RHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004124 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewNeg, AndRHS);
4125 }
4126 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004127 break;
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00004128
4129 case Instruction::Shl:
4130 case Instruction::LShr:
4131 // (1 << x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
4132 // (1 >> x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
Nick Lewyckyd8ad4922008-07-09 07:35:26 +00004133 if (AndRHSMask == 1 && Op0LHS == AndRHS) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004134 Value *NewICmp =
4135 Builder->CreateICmpEQ(Op0RHS, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00004136 return new ZExtInst(NewICmp, I.getType());
4137 }
4138 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004139 }
4140
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00004141 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004142 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00004143 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004144 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004145 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
4146 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
4147 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
4148 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004149 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004150 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004151 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004152 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
4153 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004154 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
4155 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
4156 // other simplifications.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004157 Value *NewCast = Builder->CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00004158 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
4159 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004160 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004161 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004162 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004163 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004164 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4165 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
4166 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004167 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004168 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004169 // trunc(C1)&C2
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004170 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
4171 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004172 }
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004173 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00004174 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004175
4176 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4177 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004178 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004179 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004180 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4181 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4182 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00004183 }
4184
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004185 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
4186 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004187
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00004188 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00004189 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00004190
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004191 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004192 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004193 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
4194 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004195 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Or);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004196 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004197
4198 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004199 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004200 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004201 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
4202 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004203
4204 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004205 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004206 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004207 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004208 }
4209 }
4210
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004211 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004212 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
4213 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004214
4215 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004216 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004217 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004218 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004219 }
4220 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004221
4222 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004223 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004224 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
4225 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
4226 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4227 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
4228 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
4229 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
4230 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4231 }
4232 }
Bill Wendling7f0ef6b2008-11-30 13:08:13 +00004233
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004234 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004235 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004236 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
4237 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
4238 std::swap(A, B);
4239 }
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004240 if (A == Op0) // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
4241 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Builder->CreateNot(B, "tmp"));
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004242 }
Bill Wendling7f0ef6b2008-11-30 13:08:13 +00004243
4244 // (A&((~A)|B)) -> A&B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004245 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Not(m_Specific(Op1)), m_Value(A))) ||
4246 match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Not(m_Specific(Op1)))))
Chris Lattnerd8aafcb2008-12-01 05:16:26 +00004247 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Op1);
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004248 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Not(m_Specific(Op0)), m_Value(A))) ||
4249 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Not(m_Specific(Op0)))))
Chris Lattnerd8aafcb2008-12-01 05:16:26 +00004250 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004251 }
4252
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004253 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
4254 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004255 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004256 return R;
4257
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004258 if (ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
4259 if (Instruction *Res = FoldAndOfICmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4260 return Res;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00004261 }
4262
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004263 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004264 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
4265 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
4266 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
4267 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnerf98d2532009-07-23 05:32:17 +00004268 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() &&
4269 SrcTy->isIntOrIntVector() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004270 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004271 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4272 I.getType(), TD) &&
4273 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4274 I.getType(), TD)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004275 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4276 Op1C->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004277 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004278 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004279 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004280
4281 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004282 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4283 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4284 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004285 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4286 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004287 Value *NewOp =
4288 Builder->CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0), SI1->getOperand(0),
4289 SI0->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004290 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004291 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004292 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004293 }
4294
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004295 // If and'ing two fcmp, try combine them into one.
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004296 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00004297 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4298 if (Instruction *Res = FoldAndOfFCmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4299 return Res;
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004300 }
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004301
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004302 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004303}
4304
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004305/// CollectBSwapParts - Analyze the specified subexpression and see if it is
4306/// capable of providing pieces of a bswap. The subexpression provides pieces
4307/// of a bswap if it is proven that each of the non-zero bytes in the output of
4308/// the expression came from the corresponding "byte swapped" byte in some other
4309/// value. For example, if the current subexpression is "(shl i32 %X, 24)" then
4310/// we know that the expression deposits the low byte of %X into the high byte
4311/// of the bswap result and that all other bytes are zero. This expression is
4312/// accepted, the high byte of ByteValues is set to X to indicate a correct
4313/// match.
4314///
4315/// This function returns true if the match was unsuccessful and false if so.
4316/// On entry to the function the "OverallLeftShift" is a signed integer value
4317/// indicating the number of bytes that the subexpression is later shifted. For
4318/// example, if the expression is later right shifted by 16 bits, the
4319/// OverallLeftShift value would be -2 on entry. This is used to specify which
4320/// byte of ByteValues is actually being set.
4321///
4322/// Similarly, ByteMask is a bitmask where a bit is clear if its corresponding
4323/// byte is masked to zero by a user. For example, in (X & 255), X will be
4324/// processed with a bytemask of 1. Because bytemask is 32-bits, this limits
4325/// this function to working on up to 32-byte (256 bit) values. ByteMask is
4326/// always in the local (OverallLeftShift) coordinate space.
4327///
4328static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, int OverallLeftShift, uint32_t ByteMask,
4329 SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
4330 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
4331 // If this is an or instruction, it may be an inner node of the bswap.
4332 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4333 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4334 ByteValues) ||
4335 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4336 ByteValues);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004337 }
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004338
4339 // If this is a logical shift by a constant multiple of 8, recurse with
4340 // OverallLeftShift and ByteMask adjusted.
4341 if (I->isLogicalShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4342 unsigned ShAmt =
4343 cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(~0U);
4344 // Ensure the shift amount is defined and of a byte value.
4345 if ((ShAmt & 7) || (ShAmt > 8*ByteValues.size()))
4346 return true;
4347
4348 unsigned ByteShift = ShAmt >> 3;
4349 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
4350 // X << 2 -> collect(X, +2)
4351 OverallLeftShift += ByteShift;
4352 ByteMask >>= ByteShift;
4353 } else {
4354 // X >>u 2 -> collect(X, -2)
4355 OverallLeftShift -= ByteShift;
4356 ByteMask <<= ByteShift;
Chris Lattnerde17ddc2008-10-08 06:42:28 +00004357 ByteMask &= (~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size()));
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004358 }
4359
4360 if (OverallLeftShift >= (int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4361 if (OverallLeftShift <= -(int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4362
4363 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4364 ByteValues);
4365 }
4366
4367 // If this is a logical 'and' with a mask that clears bytes, clear the
4368 // corresponding bytes in ByteMask.
4369 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
4370 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4371 // Scan every byte of the and mask, seeing if the byte is either 0 or 255.
4372 unsigned NumBytes = ByteValues.size();
4373 APInt Byte(I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), 255);
4374 const APInt &AndMask = cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getValue();
4375
4376 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumBytes; ++i, Byte <<= 8) {
4377 // If this byte is masked out by a later operation, we don't care what
4378 // the and mask is.
4379 if ((ByteMask & (1 << i)) == 0)
4380 continue;
4381
4382 // If the AndMask is all zeros for this byte, clear the bit.
4383 APInt MaskB = AndMask & Byte;
4384 if (MaskB == 0) {
4385 ByteMask &= ~(1U << i);
4386 continue;
4387 }
4388
4389 // If the AndMask is not all ones for this byte, it's not a bytezap.
4390 if (MaskB != Byte)
4391 return true;
4392
4393 // Otherwise, this byte is kept.
4394 }
4395
4396 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4397 ByteValues);
4398 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004399 }
4400
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004401 // Okay, we got to something that isn't a shift, 'or' or 'and'. This must be
4402 // the input value to the bswap. Some observations: 1) if more than one byte
4403 // is demanded from this input, then it could not be successfully assembled
4404 // into a byteswap. At least one of the two bytes would not be aligned with
4405 // their ultimate destination.
4406 if (!isPowerOf2_32(ByteMask)) return true;
4407 unsigned InputByteNo = CountTrailingZeros_32(ByteMask);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004408
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004409 // 2) The input and ultimate destinations must line up: if byte 3 of an i32
4410 // is demanded, it needs to go into byte 0 of the result. This means that the
4411 // byte needs to be shifted until it lands in the right byte bucket. The
4412 // shift amount depends on the position: if the byte is coming from the high
4413 // part of the value (e.g. byte 3) then it must be shifted right. If from the
4414 // low part, it must be shifted left.
4415 unsigned DestByteNo = InputByteNo + OverallLeftShift;
4416 if (InputByteNo < ByteValues.size()/2) {
4417 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4418 return true;
4419 } else {
4420 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4421 return true;
4422 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004423
4424 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
4425 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004426 if (ByteValues[DestByteNo] && ByteValues[DestByteNo] != V)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004427 return true;
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004428 ByteValues[DestByteNo] = V;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004429 return false;
4430}
4431
4432/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
4433/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
4434Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004435 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004436 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16 ||
4437 // ByteMask only allows up to 32-byte values.
4438 ITy->getBitWidth() > 32*8)
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004439 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004440
4441 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
4442 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00004443 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004444 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004445
4446 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004447 uint32_t ByteMask = ~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size());
4448 if (CollectBSwapParts(&I, 0, ByteMask, ByteValues))
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004449 return 0;
4450
4451 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
4452 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
4453 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
4454
4455 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
4456 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
4457 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
4458 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004459 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004460 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004461 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00004462 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004463}
4464
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004465/// MatchSelectFromAndOr - We have an expression of the form (A&C)|(B&D). Check
4466/// If A is (cond?-1:0) and either B or D is ~(cond?-1,0) or (cond?0,-1), then
4467/// we can simplify this expression to "cond ? C : D or B".
4468static Instruction *MatchSelectFromAndOr(Value *A, Value *B,
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004469 Value *C, Value *D,
4470 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004471 // If A is not a select of -1/0, this cannot match.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004472 Value *Cond = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004473 if (!match(A, m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Value(Cond))))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004474 return 0;
4475
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004476 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | (B&(cond?0:-1)) -> cond ? C : B.
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004477 if (match(D, m_SelectCst<0, -1>(m_Specific(Cond))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004478 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004479 if (match(D, m_Not(m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Specific(Cond)))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004480 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
4481 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | ((cond?0:-1)&D) -> cond ? C : D.
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004482 if (match(B, m_SelectCst<0, -1>(m_Specific(Cond))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004483 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004484 if (match(B, m_Not(m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Specific(Cond)))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004485 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004486 return 0;
4487}
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004488
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004489/// FoldOrOfICmps - Fold (icmp)|(icmp) if possible.
4490Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrOfICmps(Instruction &I,
4491 ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS) {
4492 Value *Val, *Val2;
4493 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
4494 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
4495
4496 // This only handles icmp of constants: (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 B, C2).
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004497 if (!match(LHS, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004498 m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))) ||
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004499 !match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(Val2),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004500 m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004501 return 0;
4502
4503 // From here on, we only handle:
4504 // (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
4505 if (Val != Val2) return 0;
4506
4507 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
4508 if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
4509 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
4510 LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE ||
4511 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
4512 return 0;
4513
4514 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4515 if (!PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC))
4516 return 0;
4517
4518 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
4519 bool ShouldSwap;
4520 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
4521 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
4522 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
4523 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
4524 else
4525 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
4526
4527 if (ShouldSwap) {
4528 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4529 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4530 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4531 }
4532
4533 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
4534 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4535 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
4536 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4537 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
4538 // equal.
4539 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4540
4541 switch (LHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004542 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004543 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
4544 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004545 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004546 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004547 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004548 // (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00004549 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004550 Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(Val, AddCST, Val->getName()+".off");
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004551 AddCST = ConstantExpr::getSub(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004552 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004553 }
4554 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4555 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4556 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
4557 break;
4558 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4559 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4560 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4561 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4562 }
4563 break;
4564 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
4565 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004566 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004567 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4568 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4569 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
4570 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4571 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4572 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4573 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004574 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004575 }
4576 break;
4577 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4578 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004579 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004580 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4581 break;
4582 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) -> (X-13) u> 2
4583 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4584 // this can cause overflow.
4585 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4586 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004587 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004588 false, false, I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004589 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4590 break;
4591 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4592 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4593 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4594 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4595 break;
4596 }
4597 break;
4598 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4599 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004600 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004601 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4602 break;
4603 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) -> (X-13) s> 2
4604 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4605 // this can cause overflow.
4606 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4607 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004608 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004609 true, false, I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004610 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4611 break;
4612 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4613 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4614 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4615 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4616 break;
4617 }
4618 break;
4619 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4620 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004621 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004622 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4623 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4624 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4625 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4626 break;
4627 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4628 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004629 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004630 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4631 break;
4632 }
4633 break;
4634 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4635 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004636 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004637 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4638 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4639 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4640 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4641 break;
4642 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4643 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004644 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004645 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4646 break;
4647 }
4648 break;
4649 }
4650 return 0;
4651}
4652
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004653Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS,
4654 FCmpInst *RHS) {
4655 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
4656 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
4657 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType()) {
4658 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4659 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4660 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4661 // true.
4662 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004663 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004664
4665 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4666 // rest.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004667 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO,
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004668 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
4669 }
4670
4671 // Handle vector zeros. This occurs because the canonical form of
4672 // "fcmp uno x,x" is "fcmp uno x, 0".
4673 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(LHS->getOperand(1)) &&
4674 isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(RHS->getOperand(1)))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004675 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO,
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004676 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
4677
4678 return 0;
4679 }
4680
4681 Value *Op0LHS = LHS->getOperand(0), *Op0RHS = LHS->getOperand(1);
4682 Value *Op1LHS = RHS->getOperand(0), *Op1RHS = RHS->getOperand(1);
4683 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC = LHS->getPredicate(), Op1CC = RHS->getPredicate();
4684
4685 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4686 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4687 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4688 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4689 }
4690 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4691 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) | (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4692 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00004693 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC,
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004694 Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4695 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE || Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00004696 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004697 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4698 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4699 if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4700 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4701 bool Op0Ordered;
4702 bool Op1Ordered;
4703 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4704 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4705 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered) {
4706 // If both are ordered or unordered, return a new fcmp with
4707 // or'ed predicates.
4708 Value *RV = getFCmpValue(Op0Ordered, Op0Pred|Op1Pred,
4709 Op0LHS, Op0RHS, Context);
4710 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
4711 return I;
4712 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
4713 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RV);
4714 }
4715 }
4716 return 0;
4717}
4718
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004719/// FoldOrWithConstants - This helper function folds:
4720///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00004721/// ((A | B) & C1) | (B & C2)
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004722///
4723/// into:
4724///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00004725/// (A & C1) | B
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004726///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00004727/// when the XOR of the two constants is "all ones" (-1).
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004728Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrWithConstants(BinaryOperator &I, Value *Op,
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004729 Value *A, Value *B, Value *C) {
Bill Wendlingdda74e02008-12-02 05:06:43 +00004730 ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4731 if (!CI1) return 0;
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004732
Bill Wendling286a0542008-12-02 06:24:20 +00004733 Value *V1 = 0;
4734 ConstantInt *CI2 = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004735 if (!match(Op, m_And(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CI2)))) return 0;
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004736
Bill Wendling29976b92008-12-02 06:18:11 +00004737 APInt Xor = CI1->getValue() ^ CI2->getValue();
4738 if (!Xor.isAllOnesValue()) return 0;
4739
Bill Wendling286a0542008-12-02 06:24:20 +00004740 if (V1 == A || V1 == B) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004741 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateAnd((V1 == A) ? B : A, CI1);
Bill Wendlingd16c6e92008-12-02 06:22:04 +00004742 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NewOp, V1);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004743 }
4744
4745 return 0;
4746}
4747
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004748Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004749 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004750 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004751
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004752 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00004753 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004754
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004755 // or X, X = X
4756 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004757 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004758
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004759 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4760 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00004761 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
4762 return &I;
4763 if (isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4764 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4765 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
4766 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
4767 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
4768 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
4769 }
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004770 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004771
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004772 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004773 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004774 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004775 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004776 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004777 isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004778 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004779 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004780 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00004781 ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004782 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004783
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004784 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004785 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004786 isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004787 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004788 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004789 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00004790 ConstantInt::get(*Context, C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004791 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004792
4793 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4794 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004795 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004796 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004797 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4798 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4799 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004800 }
4801
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004802 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
4803 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004804
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004805 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004806 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
4807 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004808 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004809 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
4810 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4811
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004812 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
4813 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004814 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
4815 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
4816 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
4817 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004818 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
4819 return BSwap;
4820 }
4821
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004822 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004823 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004824 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004825 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004826 Value *NOr = Builder->CreateOr(A, Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004827 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004828 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004829 }
4830
4831 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004832 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004833 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004834 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004835 Value *NOr = Builder->CreateOr(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004836 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004837 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004838 }
4839
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004840 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00004841 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004842 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
4843 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004844 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
4845 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4846 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
4847 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
4848 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
4849 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
4850 // replace with V+N.
4851 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
4852 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004853 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004854 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4855 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
4856 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4857 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
4858 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4859 }
4860 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4861 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004862 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004863 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4864 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
4865 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4866 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
4867 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4868 }
4869 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00004870 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004871 }
4872
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004873 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
4874 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004875 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
4876 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
4877 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
4878 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
4879 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
4880 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
4881 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
4882 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
4883 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
4884
4885 if (V1) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004886 Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004887 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00004888 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004889 }
Dan Gohmanb493b272008-10-28 22:38:57 +00004890
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00004891 // (A & (C0?-1:0)) | (B & ~(C0?-1:0)) -> C0 ? A : B, and commuted variants
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004892 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(A, B, C, D, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004893 return Match;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004894 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(B, A, D, C, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004895 return Match;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004896 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(C, B, A, D, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004897 return Match;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004898 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(D, A, B, C, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004899 return Match;
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004900
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004901 // ((A&~B)|(~A&B)) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004902 if ((match(C, m_Not(m_Specific(D))) &&
4903 match(B, m_Not(m_Specific(A)))))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004904 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, D);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004905 // ((~B&A)|(~A&B)) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004906 if ((match(A, m_Not(m_Specific(D))) &&
4907 match(B, m_Not(m_Specific(C)))))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004908 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, D);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004909 // ((A&~B)|(B&~A)) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004910 if ((match(C, m_Not(m_Specific(B))) &&
4911 match(D, m_Not(m_Specific(A)))))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004912 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004913 // ((~B&A)|(B&~A)) -> A^B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004914 if ((match(A, m_Not(m_Specific(B))) &&
4915 match(D, m_Not(m_Specific(C)))))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004916 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, B);
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004917 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004918
4919 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004920 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4921 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4922 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004923 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4924 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004925 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0), SI1->getOperand(0),
4926 SI0->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004927 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004928 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004929 }
4930 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00004931
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00004932 // ((A|B)&1)|(B&-2) -> (A&1) | B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004933 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), m_Value(C))) ||
4934 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))) {
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004935 Instruction *Ret = FoldOrWithConstants(I, Op1, A, B, C);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004936 if (Ret) return Ret;
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00004937 }
4938 // (B&-2)|((A|B)&1) -> (A&1) | B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004939 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), m_Value(C))) ||
4940 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))) {
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004941 Instruction *Ret = FoldOrWithConstants(I, Op0, A, B, C);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004942 if (Ret) return Ret;
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00004943 }
4944
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004945 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004946 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00004947 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004948 } else {
4949 A = 0;
4950 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004951 // Note, A is still live here!
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004952 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004953 if (Op0 == B)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00004954 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004955
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004956 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004957 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004958 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(A, B, I.getName()+".demorgan");
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00004959 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(And);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004960 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004961 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004962
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004963 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4964 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00004965 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004966 return R;
4967
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004968 if (ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
4969 if (Instruction *Res = FoldOrOfICmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4970 return Res;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004971 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004972
4973 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004974 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004975 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004976 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004977 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
4978 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
4979 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnerf98d2532009-07-23 05:32:17 +00004980 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() &&
4981 SrcTy->isIntOrIntVector() &&
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004982 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
4983 // generated.
4984 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4985 I.getType(), TD) &&
4986 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4987 I.getType(), TD)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00004988 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4989 Op1C->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004990 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004991 }
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004992 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004993 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004994 }
4995
4996
4997 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4998 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004999 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
5000 if (Instruction *Res = FoldOrOfFCmps(I, LHS, RHS))
5001 return Res;
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005002 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00005003
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005004 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005005}
5006
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00005007namespace {
5008
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00005009// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
5010struct XorSelf {
5011 Value *RHS;
5012 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
5013 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
5014 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
5015 return &Xor;
5016 }
5017};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005018
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00005019}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005020
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005021Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00005022 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005023 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005024
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00005025 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
5026 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
5027 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
5028 // idiom (misuse).
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005029 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005030 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00005031 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005032
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00005033 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005034 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00005035 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005036 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00005037 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00005038
5039 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
5040 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005041 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
5042 return &I;
5043 if (isa<VectorType>(I.getType()))
5044 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1))
5045 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005046
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005047 // Is this a ~ operation?
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005048 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005049 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
5050 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
5051 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
5052 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
5053 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005054 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
5055 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005056 Value *NotY =
5057 Builder->CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
5058 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005059 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005060 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005061 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005062 }
5063 }
5064 }
5065 }
5066
5067
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005068 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005069 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context) && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Bill Wendling3479be92009-01-01 01:18:23 +00005070 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00005071 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005072 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005073 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00005074
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00005075 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005076 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00005077 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
5078 }
5079
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005080 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
5081 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
5082 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
5083 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
5084 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005085 if ((Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) &&
5086 (RHS == ConstantExpr::getCast(Opcode,
5087 ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context),
5088 Op0C->getDestTy()))) {
5089 CI->setPredicate(CI->getInversePredicate());
5090 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, CI, Op0C->getType());
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005091 }
5092 }
5093 }
5094 }
5095
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005096 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00005097 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005098 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
5099 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005100 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
5101 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005102 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005103 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005104 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00005105
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005106 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00005107 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00005108 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005109 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005110 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005111 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005112 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005113 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005114 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00005115 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00005116 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005117 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(*Context,
5118 RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005119 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00005120
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005121 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00005122 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
5123 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00005124 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005125 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00005126 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
5127 // NewRHS.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005128 Constant *CommonBits = ConstantExpr::getAnd(Op0CI, RHS);
5129 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
5130 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00005131 Worklist.Add(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00005132 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
5133 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
5134 return &I;
5135 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00005136 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005137 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00005138 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005139
5140 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5141 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005142 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005143 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00005144 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
5145 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5146 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005147 }
5148
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005149 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005150 if (X == Op1)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005151 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005152
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005153 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005154 if (X == Op0)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005155 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005156
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005157
5158 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
5159 if (Op1I) {
5160 Value *A, *B;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005161 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005162 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005163 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005164 I.swapOperands();
5165 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005166 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005167 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005168 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005169 }
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005170 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Specific(Op0), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005171 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B); // A^(A^B) == B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005172 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Specific(Op0)))) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005173 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A); // A^(B^A) == B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005174 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005175 Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00005176 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005177 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00005178 std::swap(A, B);
5179 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005180 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005181 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
5182 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
5183 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00005184 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005185 }
5186
5187 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
5188 if (Op0I) {
5189 Value *A, *B;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005190 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005191 Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005192 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
5193 std::swap(A, B);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005194 if (B == Op1) // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
5195 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Builder->CreateNot(Op1, "tmp"));
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005196 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Specific(Op1), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005197 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B); // (A^B)^A == B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005198 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Specific(Op1)))) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005199 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A); // (B^A)^A == B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005200 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005201 Op0I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005202 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
5203 std::swap(A, B);
5204 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00005205 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005206 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Builder->CreateNot(A, "tmp"), Op1);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005207 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005208 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005209 }
5210
5211 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
5212 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
5213 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
5214 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
5215 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005216 Value *NewOp =
5217 Builder->CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op1I->getOperand(0),
5218 Op0I->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005219 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005220 Op1I->getOperand(1));
5221 }
5222
5223 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
5224 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
5225 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005226 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5227 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005228 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005229 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005230 }
5231 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005232 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5233 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005234 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005235 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005236 }
5237
5238 // (A & B)^(C & D)
5239 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005240 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5241 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005242 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
5243 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5244 if (A == C)
5245 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
5246 else if (A == D)
5247 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
5248 else if (B == C)
5249 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
5250 else if (B == D)
5251 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
5252
5253 if (X) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005254 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005255 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005256 }
5257 }
5258 }
5259
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005260 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
5261 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00005262 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00005263 return R;
5264
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005265 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005266 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005267 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005268 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
5269 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00005270 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005271 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005272 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
5273 I.getType(), TD) &&
5274 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
5275 I.getType(), TD)) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005276 Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
5277 Op1C->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005278 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005279 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005280 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005281 }
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005282
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005283 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005284}
5285
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005286static ConstantInt *ExtractElement(Constant *V, Constant *Idx,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005287 LLVMContext *Context) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005288 return cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getExtractElement(V, Idx));
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005289}
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005290
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005291static bool HasAddOverflow(ConstantInt *Result,
5292 ConstantInt *In1, ConstantInt *In2,
5293 bool IsSigned) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00005294 if (IsSigned)
5295 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
5296 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
5297 else
5298 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
5299 else
5300 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005301}
5302
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005303/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005304/// overflowed for this type.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005305static bool AddWithOverflow(Constant *&Result, Constant *In1,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005306 Constant *In2, LLVMContext *Context,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005307 bool IsSigned = false) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005308 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(In1, In2);
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005309
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005310 if (const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(In1->getType())) {
5311 for (unsigned i = 0, e = VTy->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005312 Constant *Idx = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005313 if (HasAddOverflow(ExtractElement(Result, Idx, Context),
5314 ExtractElement(In1, Idx, Context),
5315 ExtractElement(In2, Idx, Context),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005316 IsSigned))
5317 return true;
5318 }
5319 return false;
5320 }
5321
5322 return HasAddOverflow(cast<ConstantInt>(Result),
5323 cast<ConstantInt>(In1), cast<ConstantInt>(In2),
5324 IsSigned);
5325}
5326
5327static bool HasSubOverflow(ConstantInt *Result,
5328 ConstantInt *In1, ConstantInt *In2,
5329 bool IsSigned) {
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005330 if (IsSigned)
5331 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
5332 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
5333 else
5334 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
5335 else
5336 return Result->getValue().ugt(In1->getValue());
5337}
5338
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005339/// SubWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1-In2, returning true if the result
5340/// overflowed for this type.
5341static bool SubWithOverflow(Constant *&Result, Constant *In1,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005342 Constant *In2, LLVMContext *Context,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005343 bool IsSigned = false) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005344 Result = ConstantExpr::getSub(In1, In2);
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005345
5346 if (const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(In1->getType())) {
5347 for (unsigned i = 0, e = VTy->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005348 Constant *Idx = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005349 if (HasSubOverflow(ExtractElement(Result, Idx, Context),
5350 ExtractElement(In1, Idx, Context),
5351 ExtractElement(In2, Idx, Context),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005352 IsSigned))
5353 return true;
5354 }
5355 return false;
5356 }
5357
5358 return HasSubOverflow(cast<ConstantInt>(Result),
5359 cast<ConstantInt>(In1), cast<ConstantInt>(In2),
5360 IsSigned);
5361}
5362
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005363/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
5364/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
5365/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
5366static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00005367 TargetData &TD = *IC.getTargetData();
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005368 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005369 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType(I.getContext());
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005370 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005371
5372 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005373 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005374 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005375
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00005376 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
5377 ++i, ++GTI) {
5378 Value *Op = *i;
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005379 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005380 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
5381 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
5382
5383 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5384 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5385 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
5386
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005387 Result = IC.Builder->CreateAdd(Result,
5388 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
5389 GEP->getName()+".offs");
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005390 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005391 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005392
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005393 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005394 Constant *OC =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005395 ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
5396 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005397 // Emit an add instruction.
5398 Result = IC.Builder->CreateAdd(Result, Scale, GEP->getName()+".offs");
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005399 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005400 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005401 // Convert to correct type.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005402 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy)
5403 Op = IC.Builder->CreateIntCast(Op, IntPtrTy, true, Op->getName()+".c");
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005404 if (Size != 1) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005405 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005406 // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
5407 Op = IC.Builder->CreateMul(Op, Scale, GEP->getName()+".idx");
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005408 }
5409
5410 // Emit an add instruction.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005411 Result = IC.Builder->CreateAdd(Op, Result, GEP->getName()+".offs");
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005412 }
5413 return Result;
5414}
5415
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005416
Dan Gohman8f080f02009-07-17 22:16:21 +00005417/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return a value that can be used to compare
5418/// the *offset* implied by a GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we
5419/// want to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can
5420/// be complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be
5421/// legal to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32).
5422/// This later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed
5423/// to generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005424///
5425/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
5426///
5427static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
5428 InstCombiner &IC) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00005429 TargetData &TD = *IC.getTargetData();
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005430 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
5431
5432 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
5433 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
5434 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
5435 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
5436 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
5437 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
5438 int64_t Offset = 0;
5439 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5440 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
5441 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5442 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5443
5444 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5445 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5446 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5447 } else {
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005448 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005449 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5450 }
5451 } else {
5452 // Found our variable index.
5453 break;
5454 }
5455 }
5456
5457 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
5458 // evaluate it the general way.
5459 if (i == e) return 0;
5460
5461 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
5462 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
5463 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005464 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005465
5466 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
5467 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5468 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
5469 if (!CI) return 0;
5470
5471 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5472 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5473
5474 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5475 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5476 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5477 } else {
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005478 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005479 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5480 }
5481 }
5482
5483 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
5484 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
5485 // the index.
5486 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
5487 if (Offset == 0) {
5488 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
5489 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
5490 // computation crosses zero.
5491 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005492 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx,
5493 TD.getIntPtrType(VariableIdx->getContext()),
Daniel Dunbar460f6562009-07-26 09:48:23 +00005494 VariableIdx->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005495 return VariableIdx;
5496 }
5497
5498 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
5499 // the pointer size, so get it.
5500 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
5501
5502 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
5503 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
5504
5505 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
5506 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
5507 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
5508 // multiple of the variable scale.
5509 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
5510 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
5511 return 0;
5512
5513 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005514 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType(VariableIdx->getContext());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005515 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005516 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005517 true /*SExt*/,
Daniel Dunbar460f6562009-07-26 09:48:23 +00005518 VariableIdx->getName(), &I);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00005519 Constant *OffsetVal = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005520 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005521}
5522
5523
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005524/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005525/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00005526Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(GEPOperator *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005527 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
5528 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005529 // Look through bitcasts.
5530 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
5531 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005532
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005533 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00005534 if (TD && PtrBase == RHS && GEPLHS->isInBounds()) {
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005535 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005536 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00005537 // know pointers can't overflow since the gep is inbounds. See if we can
5538 // output an optimized form.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005539 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5540
5541 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
5542 if (Offset == 0)
5543 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005544 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005545 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00005546 } else if (GEPOperator *GEPRHS = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005547 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
5548 // compare the base pointer.
5549 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
5550 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005551 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00005552 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005553 if (IndicesTheSame)
5554 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5555 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
5556 IndicesTheSame = false;
5557 break;
5558 }
5559
5560 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
5561 if (IndicesTheSame)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005562 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005563 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005564
5565 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
5566 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005567 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005568 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005569
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005570 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
5571 bool AllZeros = true;
5572 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5573 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5574 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5575 AllZeros = false;
5576 break;
5577 }
5578 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005579 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
5580 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005581
5582 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005583 AllZeros = true;
5584 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5585 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5586 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5587 AllZeros = false;
5588 break;
5589 }
5590 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005591 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005592
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005593 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
5594 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
5595 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
5596 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
5597 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5598 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005599 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
5600 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005601 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005602 NumDifferences = 2;
5603 break;
5604 } else {
5605 if (NumDifferences++) break;
5606 DiffOperand = i;
5607 }
5608 }
5609
5610 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
5611 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005612 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005613 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005614
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005615 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005616 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
5617 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005618 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005619 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005620 }
5621 }
5622
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005623 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005624 // the result to fold to a constant!
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00005625 if (TD &&
5626 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005627 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
5628 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
5629 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5630 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005631 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005632 }
5633 }
5634 return 0;
5635}
5636
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005637/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
5638///
5639Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
5640 Instruction *LHSI,
5641 Constant *RHSC) {
5642 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
5643 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
5644
5645 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
5646 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00005647 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005648 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
5649
5650 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
5651 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
5652 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005653 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005654
5655 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005656 bool LHSUnsigned = isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI);
5657 if (LHSUnsigned)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005658 ++InputSize;
5659
5660 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
5661 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
5662 return 0;
5663
5664 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
5665 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
5666 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
5667 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
5668
5669 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
5670 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005671 default: llvm_unreachable("Unexpected predicate!");
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005672 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005673 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ:
5674 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ;
5675 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005676 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005677 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT:
5678 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5679 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005680 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005681 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE:
5682 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5683 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005684 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005685 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT:
5686 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5687 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005688 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005689 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE:
5690 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5691 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005692 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005693 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE:
5694 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5695 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005696 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005697 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005698 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005699 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005700 }
5701
5702 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
5703
5704 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
5705
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005706 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005707 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005708 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005709
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005710 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5711 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
5712 // and large values.
5713 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5714 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
5715 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5716 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
5717 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
5718 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005719 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
5720 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005721 }
5722 } else {
5723 // If the RHS value is > UnsignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles
5724 // +INF and large values.
5725 APFloat UMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5726 UMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getMaxValue(IntWidth), false,
5727 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5728 if (UMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // umax < 13123.0
5729 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5730 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005731 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
5732 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005733 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005734 }
5735
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005736 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5737 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
5738 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5739 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
5740 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5741 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
5742 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
5743 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005744 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
5745 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005746 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005747 }
5748
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005749 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] or
5750 // [0, UMAX], but it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by
5751 // casting the FP value to the integer value and back, checking for equality.
5752 // Don't do this for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005753 Constant *RHSInt = LHSUnsigned
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005754 ? ConstantExpr::getFPToUI(RHSC, IntTy)
5755 : ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005756 if (!RHS.isZero()) {
5757 bool Equal = LHSUnsigned
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005758 ? ConstantExpr::getUIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) == RHSC
5759 : ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) == RHSC;
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005760 if (!Equal) {
5761 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust
5762 // the compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards
5763 // zero at this point.
5764 switch (Pred) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005765 default: llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer comparison!");
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005766 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005767 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005768 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005769 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005770 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5771 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5772 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> false
5773 if (RHS.isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005774 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005775 break;
5776 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5777 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5778 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
5779 if (RHS.isNegative())
5780 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5781 break;
5782 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5783 // (float)int < -4.4 --> false
5784 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5785 if (RHS.isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005786 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005787 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE;
5788 break;
5789 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5790 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
5791 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5792 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5793 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5794 break;
5795 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5796 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5797 // (float)int > -4.4 --> true
5798 if (RHS.isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005799 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005800 break;
5801 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5802 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5803 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5804 if (RHS.isNegative())
5805 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5806 break;
5807 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5808 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> true
5809 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5810 if (!RHS.isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005811 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005812 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
5813 break;
5814 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5815 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
5816 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5817 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5818 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5819 break;
5820 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005821 }
5822 }
5823
5824 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
5825 // comparison.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00005826 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005827}
5828
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005829Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
5830 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005831 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005832
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005833 // Fold trivial predicates.
5834 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005835 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 0));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005836 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005837 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005838
5839 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
5840 if (Op0 == Op1) {
5841 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005842 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown predicate!");
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005843 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
5844 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
5845 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005846 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005847 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
5848 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
5849 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005850 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 0));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005851
5852 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
5853 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
5854 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
5855 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
5856 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
5857 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005858 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005859 return &I;
5860
5861 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
5862 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
5863 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
5864 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
5865 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
5866 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00005867 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005868 return &I;
5869 }
5870 }
5871
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005872 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005873 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005874
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005875 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
5876 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005877 // If the constant is a nan, see if we can fold the comparison based on it.
5878 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
5879 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isNaN()) {
5880 if (FCmpInst::isOrdered(I.getPredicate())) // True if ordered and...
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005881 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005882 assert(FCmpInst::isUnordered(I.getPredicate()) &&
5883 "Comparison must be either ordered or unordered!");
5884 // True if unordered.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00005885 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005886 }
5887 }
5888
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005889 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5890 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5891 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005892 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5893 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5894 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5895 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00005896 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I, true))
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005897 return NV;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005898 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005899 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5900 case Instruction::UIToFP:
5901 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
5902 return NV;
5903 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005904 case Instruction::Select:
5905 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5906 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5907 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5908 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5909 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5910 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5911 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005912 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005913 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005914 Op2 = Builder->CreateFCmp(I.getPredicate(),
5915 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC, I.getName());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005916 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5917 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00005918 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005919 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005920 Op1 = Builder->CreateFCmp(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(1),
5921 RHSC, I.getName());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005922 }
5923 }
5924
5925 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005926 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005927 break;
5928 }
5929 }
5930
5931 return Changed ? &I : 0;
5932}
5933
5934Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
5935 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5936 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5937 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
5938
5939 // icmp X, X
5940 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005941 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(),
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005942 I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005943
5944 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Chris Lattner9e17b632009-09-02 05:12:37 +00005945 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00005946
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005947 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005948 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Chris Lattnerbbc33852009-10-05 02:47:47 +00005949 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005950 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
Chris Lattnerbbc33852009-10-05 02:47:47 +00005951 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005952 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005953 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005954 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005955
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005956 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00005957 if (Ty == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005958 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005959 default: llvm_unreachable("Invalid icmp instruction!");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005960 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq i1 A, B -> ~(A^B)
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005961 Value *Xor = Builder->CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00005962 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005963 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005964 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq i1 A, B -> A^B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005965 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005966
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005967 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005968 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ugt -> icmp ult
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005969 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005970 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:{ // icmp ult i1 A, B -> ~A & B
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005971 Value *Not = Builder->CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005972 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005973 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005974 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5975 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sgt -> icmp slt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005976 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005977 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp slt i1 A, B -> A & ~B
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005978 Value *Not = Builder->CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005979 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op0);
5980 }
5981 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5982 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp uge -> icmp ule
5983 // FALL THROUGH
5984 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: { // icmp ule i1 A, B -> ~A | B
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005985 Value *Not = Builder->CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005986 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005987 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005988 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5989 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sge -> icmp sle
5990 // FALL THROUGH
5991 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp sle i1 A, B -> A | ~B
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00005992 Value *Not = Builder->CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005993 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op0);
5994 }
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005995 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005996 }
5997
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00005998 unsigned BitWidth = 0;
5999 if (TD)
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00006000 BitWidth = TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Ty->getScalarType());
6001 else if (Ty->isIntOrIntVector())
6002 BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006003
6004 bool isSignBit = false;
6005
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00006006 // See if we are doing a comparison with a constant.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00006007 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky579214a2009-02-27 06:37:39 +00006008 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00006009
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00006010 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
6011 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006012 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00006013 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006014 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00006015 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00006016
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00006017 // If we have an icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
6018 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. This allows us to rely on
6019 // them being folded in the code below.
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006020 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
6021 default: break;
6022 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
6023 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006024 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006025 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006026 AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006027 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
6028 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006029 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006030 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006031 AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006032 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
6033 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006034 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006035 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006036 SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006037 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
6038 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006039 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006040 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006041 SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006042 }
6043
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00006044 // If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00006045 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00006046 bool UnusedBit;
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006047 isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
6048 }
6049
6050 // See if we can fold the comparison based on range information we can get
6051 // by checking whether bits are known to be zero or one in the input.
6052 if (BitWidth != 0) {
6053 APInt Op0KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), Op0KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6054 APInt Op1KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), Op1KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6055
6056 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I.getOperandUse(0),
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00006057 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
6058 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006059 Op0KnownZero, Op0KnownOne, 0))
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00006060 return &I;
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006061 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I.getOperandUse(1),
6062 APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
6063 Op1KnownZero, Op1KnownOne, 0))
6064 return &I;
6065
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00006066 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006067 // in. Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
6068 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006069 APInt Op0Min(BitWidth, 0), Op0Max(BitWidth, 0);
6070 APInt Op1Min(BitWidth, 0), Op1Max(BitWidth, 0);
6071 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate())) {
6072 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op0KnownZero, Op0KnownOne,
6073 Op0Min, Op0Max);
6074 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op1KnownZero, Op1KnownOne,
6075 Op1Min, Op1Max);
6076 } else {
6077 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op0KnownZero, Op0KnownOne,
6078 Op0Min, Op0Max);
6079 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op1KnownZero, Op1KnownOne,
6080 Op1Min, Op1Max);
6081 }
6082
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00006083 // If Min and Max are known to be the same, then SimplifyDemandedBits
6084 // figured out that the LHS is a constant. Just constant fold this now so
6085 // that code below can assume that Min != Max.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006086 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0) && Op0Min == Op0Max)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006087 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006088 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Op0Min), Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006089 if (!isa<Constant>(Op1) && Op1Min == Op1Max)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006090 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006091 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Op1Min));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006092
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00006093 // Based on the range information we know about the LHS, see if we can
6094 // simplify this comparison. For example, (x&4) < 8 is always true.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006095 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00006096 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown icmp opcode!");
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006097 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006098 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min) || Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max))
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006099 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006100 break;
6101 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006102 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min) || Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max))
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006103 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006104 break;
6105 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006106 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min)) // A <u B -> true if max(A) < min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006107 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006108 if (Op0Min.uge(Op1Max)) // A <u B -> false if min(A) >= max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006109 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006110 if (Op1Min == Op0Max) // A <u B -> A != B if max(A) == min(B)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006111 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006112 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6113 if (Op1Max == Op0Min+1) // A <u C -> A == C-1 if min(A)+1 == C
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006114 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006115 SubOne(CI));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006116
6117 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
6118 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006119 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006120 Constant::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006121 }
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006122 break;
6123 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006124 if (Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max)) // A >u B -> true if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006125 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006126 if (Op0Max.ule(Op1Min)) // A >u B -> false if max(A) <= max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006127 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006128
6129 if (Op1Max == Op0Min) // A >u B -> A != B if min(A) == max(B)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006130 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006131 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6132 if (Op1Min == Op0Max-1) // A >u C -> A == C+1 if max(a)-1 == C
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006133 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006134 AddOne(CI));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006135
6136 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
6137 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006138 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006139 Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006140 }
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006141 break;
6142 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006143 if (Op0Max.slt(Op1Min)) // A <s B -> true if max(A) < min(C)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006144 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006145 if (Op0Min.sge(Op1Max)) // A <s B -> false if min(A) >= max(C)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006146 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006147 if (Op1Min == Op0Max) // A <s B -> A != B if max(A) == min(B)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006148 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006149 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6150 if (Op1Max == Op0Min+1) // A <s C -> A == C-1 if min(A)+1 == C
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006151 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006152 SubOne(CI));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006153 }
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006154 break;
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006155 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
6156 if (Op0Min.sgt(Op1Max)) // A >s B -> true if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006157 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006158 if (Op0Max.sle(Op1Min)) // A >s B -> false if max(A) <= min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006159 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006160
6161 if (Op1Max == Op0Min) // A >s B -> A != B if min(A) == max(B)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006162 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006163 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6164 if (Op1Min == Op0Max-1) // A >s C -> A == C+1 if max(A)-1 == C
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006165 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006166 AddOne(CI));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006167 }
6168 break;
6169 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
6170 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_SGE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6171 if (Op0Min.sge(Op1Max)) // A >=s B -> true if min(A) >= max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006172 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006173 if (Op0Max.slt(Op1Min)) // A >=s B -> false if max(A) < min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006174 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006175 break;
6176 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
6177 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_SLE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6178 if (Op0Max.sle(Op1Min)) // A <=s B -> true if max(A) <= min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006179 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006180 if (Op0Min.sgt(Op1Max)) // A <=s B -> false if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006181 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006182 break;
6183 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
6184 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_UGE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6185 if (Op0Min.uge(Op1Max)) // A >=u B -> true if min(A) >= max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006186 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006187 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min)) // A >=u B -> false if max(A) < min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006188 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006189 break;
6190 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
6191 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_ULE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6192 if (Op0Max.ule(Op1Min)) // A <=u B -> true if max(A) <= min(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006193 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006194 if (Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max)) // A <=u B -> false if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006195 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006196 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00006197 }
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006198
6199 // Turn a signed comparison into an unsigned one if both operands
6200 // are known to have the same sign.
6201 if (I.isSignedPredicate() &&
6202 ((Op0KnownZero.isNegative() && Op1KnownZero.isNegative()) ||
6203 (Op0KnownOne.isNegative() && Op1KnownOne.isNegative())))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006204 return new ICmpInst(I.getUnsignedPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00006205 }
6206
6207 // Test if the ICmpInst instruction is used exclusively by a select as
6208 // part of a minimum or maximum operation. If so, refrain from doing
6209 // any other folding. This helps out other analyses which understand
6210 // non-obfuscated minimum and maximum idioms, such as ScalarEvolution
6211 // and CodeGen. And in this case, at least one of the comparison
6212 // operands has at least one user besides the compare (the select),
6213 // which would often largely negate the benefit of folding anyway.
6214 if (I.hasOneUse())
6215 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(*I.use_begin()))
6216 if ((SI->getOperand(1) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(2) == Op1) ||
6217 (SI->getOperand(2) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(1) == Op1))
6218 return 0;
6219
6220 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
6221 // can be folded into the comparison.
6222 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006223 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00006224 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006225 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00006226 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006227 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
6228 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006229 }
6230
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006231 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006232 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
6233 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
6234 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00006235 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
6236 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006237 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00006238 bool isAllZeros = true;
6239 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
6240 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
6241 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
6242 isAllZeros = false;
6243 break;
6244 }
6245 if (isAllZeros)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006246 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006247 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00006248 }
6249 break;
6250
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006251 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00006252 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and icmp are in the same
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00006253 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
6254 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
6255 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Chris Lattner213cd612009-09-27 20:46:36 +00006256 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I, true))
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00006257 return NV;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006258 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00006259 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006260 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
6261 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
6262 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
6263 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
6264 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6265 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
6266 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006267 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006268 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006269 Op2 = Builder->CreateICmp(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(2),
6270 RHSC, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006271 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
6272 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006273 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006274 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006275 Op1 = Builder->CreateICmp(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(1),
6276 RHSC, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006277 }
6278 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00006279
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006280 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00006281 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006282 break;
6283 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00006284 case Instruction::Malloc:
6285 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
6286 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
6287 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00006288 Worklist.Add(LHSI);
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +00006289 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
6290 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
6291 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
6292 }
6293 break;
6294 case Instruction::Call:
6295 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
6296 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
6297 if (isMalloc(LHSI) && LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6298 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
6299 Worklist.Add(LHSI);
6300 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,
6301 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
6302 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
6303 }
6304 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00006305 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006306 }
6307
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006308 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00006309 if (GEPOperator *GEP = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006310 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00006311 return NI;
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +00006312 if (GEPOperator *GEP = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006313 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
6314 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00006315 return NI;
6316
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006317 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006318 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
6319 // now.
6320 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
6321 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
6322 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006323 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
6324 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006325 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006326
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006327 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
6328 // so eliminate it as well.
6329 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
6330 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006331
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006332 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006333 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006334 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006335 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006336 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006337 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00006338 Op1 = Builder->CreateBitCast(Op1, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006339 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006340 }
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006341 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006342 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006343 }
6344
6345 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006346 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00006347 // This comes up when you have code like
6348 // int X = A < B;
6349 // if (X) ...
6350 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006351 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
6352 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006353 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006354 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00006355 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006356
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006357 // See if it's the same type of instruction on the left and right.
6358 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6359 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006360 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006361 Op1I->hasOneUse() && Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1)) {
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00006362 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006363 default: break;
6364 case Instruction::Add:
6365 case Instruction::Sub:
6366 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006367 if (I.isEquality()) // a+x icmp eq/ne b+x --> a icmp b
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006368 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0I->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006369 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006370 // icmp u/s (a ^ signbit), (b ^ signbit) --> icmp s/u a, b
6371 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
6372 if (CI->getValue().isSignBit()) {
6373 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = I.isSignedPredicate()
6374 ? I.getUnsignedPredicate()
6375 : I.getSignedPredicate();
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006376 return new ICmpInst(Pred, Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006377 Op1I->getOperand(0));
6378 }
6379
6380 if (CI->getValue().isMaxSignedValue()) {
6381 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = I.isSignedPredicate()
6382 ? I.getUnsignedPredicate()
6383 : I.getSignedPredicate();
6384 Pred = I.getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006385 return new ICmpInst(Pred, Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006386 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006387 }
6388 }
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006389 break;
6390 case Instruction::Mul:
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006391 if (!I.isEquality())
6392 break;
6393
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006394 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
6395 // a * Cst icmp eq/ne b * Cst --> a & Mask icmp b & Mask
6396 // Mask = -1 >> count-trailing-zeros(Cst).
6397 if (!CI->isZero() && !CI->isOne()) {
6398 const APInt &AP = CI->getValue();
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006399 ConstantInt *Mask = ConstantInt::get(*Context,
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006400 APInt::getLowBitsSet(AP.getBitWidth(),
6401 AP.getBitWidth() -
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006402 AP.countTrailingZeros()));
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006403 Value *And1 = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0), Mask);
6404 Value *And2 = Builder->CreateAnd(Op1I->getOperand(0), Mask);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006405 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And1, And2);
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006406 }
6407 }
6408 break;
6409 }
6410 }
6411 }
6412 }
6413
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006414 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
6415 { Value *A, *B;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006416 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A))) &&
6417 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B))))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006418 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, A);
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006419 }
6420
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00006421 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006422 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006423
6424 // -x == -y --> x == y
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006425 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A))) &&
6426 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B))))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006427 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006428
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006429 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006430 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
6431 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006432 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006433 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006434 }
6435
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006436 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006437 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006438 ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006439 if (match(B, m_ConstantInt(C1)) &&
6440 match(D, m_ConstantInt(C2)) && Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006441 Constant *NC =
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006442 ConstantInt::get(*Context, C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006443 Value *Xor = Builder->CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
6444 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, Xor);
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006445 }
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006446
6447 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006448 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
6449 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
6450 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
6451 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006452 }
6453 }
6454
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006455 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006456 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006457 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
6458 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006459 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006460 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006461 }
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006462
6463 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006464 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Specific(Op1), m_Value(B))))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006465 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006466 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006467
6468 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006469 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Specific(Op0), m_Value(B))))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006470 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006471 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006472
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006473 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
6474 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00006475 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
6476 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006477 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
6478
6479 if (A == C) {
6480 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
6481 } else if (A == D) {
6482 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
6483 } else if (B == C) {
6484 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
6485 } else if (B == D) {
6486 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
6487 }
6488
6489 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006490 Op1 = Builder->CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp");
6491 Op1 = Builder->CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006492 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006493 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006494 return &I;
6495 }
6496 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006497 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006498 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006499}
6500
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006501
6502/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
6503/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
6504Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
6505 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
6506 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6507 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
6508
6509 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
6510 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
6511 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
6512 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
6513 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
6514 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
6515 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
6516 // if it finds it.
6517 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
6518 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
6519 return 0;
6520 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006521 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006522 if (DivIsSigned && DivRHS->isAllOnesValue())
6523 return 0; // The overflow computation also screws up here
6524 if (DivRHS->isOne())
6525 return 0; // Not worth bothering, and eliminates some funny cases
6526 // with INT_MIN.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006527
6528 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
6529 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
6530 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
6531 // instead of computing a divide.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006532 Constant *Prod = ConstantExpr::getMul(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006533
6534 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
6535 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
6536 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006537 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
6538 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006539
6540 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006541 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006542
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006543 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
6544 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
6545 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
6546 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
6547 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
6548 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
6549 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
6550 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00006551 Constant *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006552
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006553 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006554 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006555 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006556 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6557 if (!HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006558 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, Context, false);
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006559 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006560 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006561 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006562 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006563 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006564 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006565 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
6566 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6567 if (!HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006568 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, Context, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006569 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006570 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006571 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006572 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
6573 if (!LoOverflow) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006574 ConstantInt* DivNeg =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006575 cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006576 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivNeg, Context,
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006577 true) ? -1 : 0;
6578 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006579 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006580 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006581 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006582 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006583 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006584 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006585 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
6586 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
6587 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
6588 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006589 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006590 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006591 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006592 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006593 if (!LoOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006594 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound,
6595 DivRHS, Context, true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006596 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006597 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
6598 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
Dan Gohman7f85fbd2008-09-11 00:25:00 +00006599 if (!HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006600 HiOverflow = SubWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, Context, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006601 }
6602
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006603 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
6604 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006605 }
6606
6607 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006608 switch (Pred) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00006609 default: llvm_unreachable("Unhandled icmp opcode!");
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006610 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
6611 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006612 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006613 else if (HiOverflow)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006614 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006615 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
6616 else if (LoOverflow)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006617 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006618 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
6619 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006620 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006621 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
6622 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006623 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006624 else if (HiOverflow)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006625 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006626 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
6627 else if (LoOverflow)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006628 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006629 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6630 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006631 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006632 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
6633 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006634 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006635 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006636 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006637 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006638 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006639 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
6640 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006641 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006642 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006643 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006644 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006645 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006646 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006647 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006648 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006649 }
6650}
6651
6652
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006653/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
6654///
6655Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
6656 Instruction *LHSI,
6657 ConstantInt *RHS) {
6658 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
6659
6660 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnera80d6682009-01-09 07:47:06 +00006661 case Instruction::Trunc:
6662 if (ICI.isEquality() && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6663 // Simplify icmp eq (trunc x to i8), 42 -> icmp eq x, 42|highbits if all
6664 // of the high bits truncated out of x are known.
6665 unsigned DstBits = LHSI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(),
6666 SrcBits = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6667 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(SrcBits, SrcBits-DstBits));
6668 APInt KnownZero(SrcBits, 0), KnownOne(SrcBits, 0);
6669 ComputeMaskedBits(LHSI->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
6670
6671 // If all the high bits are known, we can do this xform.
6672 if ((KnownZero|KnownOne).countLeadingOnes() >= SrcBits-DstBits) {
6673 // Pull in the high bits from known-ones set.
6674 APInt NewRHS(RHS->getValue());
6675 NewRHS.zext(SrcBits);
6676 NewRHS |= KnownOne;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006677 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006678 ConstantInt::get(*Context, NewRHS));
Chris Lattnera80d6682009-01-09 07:47:06 +00006679 }
6680 }
6681 break;
6682
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00006683 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006684 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
6685 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
6686 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006687 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
6688 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006689 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
6690
6691 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
6692 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
6693 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
6694 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00006695 Worklist.Add(LHSI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006696 return &ICI;
6697 }
6698
6699 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
6700 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
6701
6702 // If so, the new one isn't.
6703 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
6704
6705 if (isTrueIfPositive)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006706 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006707 SubOne(RHS));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006708 else
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006709 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal,
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00006710 AddOne(RHS));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006711 }
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006712
6713 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6714 // (icmp u/s (xor A SignBit), C) -> (icmp s/u A, (xor C SignBit))
6715 if (!ICI.isEquality() && XorCST->getValue().isSignBit()) {
6716 const APInt &SignBit = XorCST->getValue();
6717 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.isSignedPredicate()
6718 ? ICI.getUnsignedPredicate()
6719 : ICI.getSignedPredicate();
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006720 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006721 ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHSV ^ SignBit));
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006722 }
6723
6724 // (icmp u/s (xor A ~SignBit), C) -> (icmp s/u (xor C ~SignBit), A)
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006725 if (!ICI.isEquality() && XorCST->getValue().isMaxSignedValue()) {
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006726 const APInt &NotSignBit = XorCST->getValue();
6727 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.isSignedPredicate()
6728 ? ICI.getUnsignedPredicate()
6729 : ICI.getSignedPredicate();
6730 Pred = ICI.getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006731 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006732 ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHSV ^ NotSignBit));
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006733 }
6734 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006735 }
6736 break;
6737 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
6738 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
6739 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
6740 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6741
6742 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
6743 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
6744 // produced, eliminating a cast.
6745 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
6746 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
6747 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
6748 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
6749 // bit would not work.
6750 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov4aefd6b2008-02-20 12:07:57 +00006751 (ICI.isEquality() ||
6752 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006753 uint32_t BitWidth =
6754 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
6755 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
6756 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
6757 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
6758 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006759 Value *NewAnd =
6760 Builder->CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006761 ConstantInt::get(*Context, NewCST), LHSI->getName());
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006762 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006763 ConstantInt::get(*Context, NewCI));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006764 }
6765 }
6766
6767 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
6768 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
6769 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
6770 // access.
6771 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
6772 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
6773 Shift = 0;
6774
6775 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
6776 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
6777 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
6778 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
6779
6780 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
6781 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
6782 // rights, as they sign-extend.
6783 if (ShAmt) {
6784 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
6785 if (!CanFold) {
6786 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
6787 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
6788 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6789 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
6790
6791 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6792 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
6793 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
6794 CanFold = true;
6795 }
6796
6797 if (CanFold) {
6798 Constant *NewCst;
6799 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006800 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006801 else
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006802 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006803
6804 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
6805 // compared.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006806 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006807 NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006808 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
6809 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
6810 // result is always true or false now.
6811 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006812 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006813 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00006814 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006815 } else {
6816 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
6817 Constant *NewAndCST;
6818 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006819 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006820 else
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006821 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006822 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
6823 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00006824 Worklist.Add(Shift); // Shift is dead.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006825 return &ICI;
6826 }
6827 }
6828 }
6829
6830 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
6831 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
6832 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
6833 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
Chris Lattnere8e49212009-03-25 00:28:58 +00006834 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
6835 !isa<Constant>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006836 // Compute C << Y.
6837 Value *NS;
6838 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006839 NS = Builder->CreateShl(AndCST, Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006840 } else {
6841 // Insert a logical shift.
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006842 NS = Builder->CreateLShr(AndCST, Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006843 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006844
6845 // Compute X & (C << Y).
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006846 Value *NewAnd =
6847 Builder->CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006848
6849 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
6850 return &ICI;
6851 }
6852 }
6853 break;
6854
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006855 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
6856 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6857 if (!ShAmt) break;
6858
6859 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6860
6861 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6862 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6863 // simplified.
6864 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6865 break;
6866
6867 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6868 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6869 // comparison cannot succeed.
6870 Constant *Comp =
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006871 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006872 ShAmt);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006873 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6874 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00006875 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context), IsICMP_NE);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006876 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6877 }
6878
6879 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6880 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6881 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6882 Constant *Mask =
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006883 ConstantInt::get(*Context, APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006884 TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006885
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006886 Value *And =
6887 Builder->CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006888 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006889 ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006890 }
6891 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006892
6893 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
6894 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
6895 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6896 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
6897 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006898 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(*Context, APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006899 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006900 Value *And =
6901 Builder->CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0), Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006902 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00006903 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006904 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006905 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006906 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006907
6908 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006909 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006910 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006911 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006912 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006913
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006914 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6915 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6916 // simplified.
6917 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6918 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6919 break;
6920
6921 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006922
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006923 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6924 // comparison cannot succeed.
6925 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
6926 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
6927 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
6928 else
6929 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
6930
6931 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6932 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00006933 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context), IsICMP_NE);
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006934 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6935 }
6936
6937 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
6938 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
6939 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006940 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6941 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006942 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006943 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006944 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006945 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006946
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006947 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006948 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6949 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006950 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(*Context, Val);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006951
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00006952 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
6953 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006954 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00006955 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006956 }
6957 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006958 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006959
6960 case Instruction::SDiv:
6961 case Instruction::UDiv:
6962 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
6963 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
6964 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
6965 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
6966 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
6967 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006968 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
6969 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
6970 DivRHS))
6971 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006972 break;
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006973
6974 case Instruction::Add:
6975 // Fold: icmp pred (add, X, C1), C2
6976
6977 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
6978 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6979 if (!LHSC) break;
6980 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
6981
6982 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
6983 .subtract(LHSV);
6984
6985 if (ICI.isSignedPredicate()) {
6986 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006987 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006988 ConstantInt::get(*Context, CR.getUpper()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006989 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006990 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006991 ConstantInt::get(*Context, CR.getLower()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006992 }
6993 } else {
6994 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006995 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006996 ConstantInt::get(*Context, CR.getUpper()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006997 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00006998 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00006999 ConstantInt::get(*Context, CR.getLower()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007000 }
7001 }
7002 }
7003 break;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007004 }
7005
7006 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
7007 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
7008 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
7009
7010 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
7011 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
7012 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
7013 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
7014 case Instruction::SRem:
7015 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
7016 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
7017 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
7018 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007019 Value *NewRem =
7020 Builder->CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
7021 BO->getName());
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007022 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007023 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007024 }
7025 }
7026 break;
7027 case Instruction::Add:
7028 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
7029 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
7030 if (BO->hasOneUse())
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007031 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007032 ConstantExpr::getSub(RHS, BOp1C));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007033 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
7034 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
7035 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
7036 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
7037
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00007038 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007039 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00007040 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007041 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007042 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007043 Value *Neg = Builder->CreateNeg(BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007044 Neg->takeName(BO);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007045 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007046 }
7047 }
7048 break;
7049 case Instruction::Xor:
7050 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
7051 // the explicit xor.
7052 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007053 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007054 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007055
7056 // FALLTHROUGH
7057 case Instruction::Sub:
7058 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
7059 if (RHSV == 0)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007060 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007061 BO->getOperand(1));
7062 break;
7063
7064 case Instruction::Or:
7065 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
7066 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
7067 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007068 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
7069 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007070 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007071 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007072 isICMP_NE));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007073 }
7074 break;
7075
7076 case Instruction::And:
7077 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
7078 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
7079 // comparison can never succeed!
7080 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007081 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI,
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007082 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007083 isICMP_NE));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007084
7085 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
7086 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007087 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007088 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007089 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007090
7091 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00007092 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007093 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007094 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007095 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
7096 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007097 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007098 }
7099
7100 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
7101 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
7102 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007103 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007104 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
7105 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007106 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007107 }
7108 }
7109 default: break;
7110 }
7111 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
7112 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
7113 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00007114 Worklist.Add(II);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007115 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007116 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(*Context, RHSV.byteSwap()));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007117 return &ICI;
7118 }
7119 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007120 }
7121 return 0;
7122}
7123
7124/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
7125/// We only handle extending casts so far.
7126///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007127Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
7128 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007129 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
7130 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007131 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007132 Value *RHSCIOp;
7133
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007134 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
7135 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00007136 if (TD && LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
7137 TD->getPointerSizeInBits() ==
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007138 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
7139 Value *RHSOp = 0;
7140 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007141 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007142 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
7143 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
7144 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
7145 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00007146 RHSOp = Builder->CreateBitCast(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType());
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007147 }
7148
7149 if (RHSOp)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007150 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007151 }
7152
7153 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
7154 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007155 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
7156 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00007157 return 0;
7158
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007159 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
7160 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007161
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007162 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007163 // Not an extension from the same type?
7164 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007165 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
7166 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00007167
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007168 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00007169 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
7170 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
7171 return 0;
7172
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007173 // Deal with equality cases early.
7174 if (ICI.isEquality())
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007175 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007176
7177 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
7178 // signed comparison.
7179 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007180 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007181
7182 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007183 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00007184 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007185
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007186 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
7187 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
7188 if (!CI)
7189 return 0;
7190
7191 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
7192 // reextended to DestTy.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007193 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
7194 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007195 Res1, DestTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007196
7197 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
7198 if (Res2 == CI) {
7199 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
7200 // For example, we might have:
Dan Gohmana119de82009-06-14 23:30:43 +00007201 // %A = sext i16 %X to i32
7202 // %B = icmp ugt i32 %A, 1330
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007203 // It is incorrect to transform this into
Dan Gohmana119de82009-06-14 23:30:43 +00007204 // %B = icmp ugt i16 %X, 1330
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007205 // because %A may have negative value.
7206 //
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007207 // However, we allow this when the compare is EQ/NE, because they are
7208 // signless.
7209 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || ICI.isEquality())
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00007210 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007211 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007212 }
7213
7214 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
7215 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
7216
7217 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
7218 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
7219 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007220 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007221 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007222 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007223
7224 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
7225 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
7226 Value *Result;
7227 if (isSignedCmp) {
7228 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00007229 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007230 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(*Context); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007231 else
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007232 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007233 } else {
7234 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
7235 if (isSignedExt) {
7236 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
7237 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007238 Constant *NegOne = Constant::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007239 Result = Builder->CreateICmpSGT(LHSCIOp, NegOne, ICI.getName());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007240 } else {
7241 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00007242 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007243 }
7244 }
7245
7246 // Finally, return the value computed.
7247 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007248 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007249 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007250
7251 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
7252 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
7253 "ICmp should be folded!");
7254 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007255 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00007256 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Result);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007257}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007258
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007259Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
7260 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
7261}
7262
7263Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
7264 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
7265}
7266
7267Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00007268 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
7269 return R;
7270
7271 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
7272
7273 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
7274 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
7275 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
7276 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
Dan Gohman0001e562009-02-24 02:00:40 +00007277
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00007278 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
7279 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
7280 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits())))
7281 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
7282
7283 // Arithmetic shifting an all-sign-bit value is a no-op.
7284 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op0);
7285 if (NumSignBits == Op0->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits())
7286 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Dan Gohman0001e562009-02-24 02:00:40 +00007287
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00007288 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007289}
7290
7291Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
7292 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00007293 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007294
7295 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
7296 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007297 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
7298 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00007299 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00007300
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007301 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
7302 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00007303 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007304 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007305 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007306 }
7307 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007308 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
7309 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
7310 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007311 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007312 }
7313
Dan Gohman9004c8a2009-05-21 02:28:33 +00007314 // See if we can fold away this shift.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007315 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
Dan Gohman9004c8a2009-05-21 02:28:33 +00007316 return &I;
7317
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007318 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
7319 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
7320 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007321 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007322 return R;
7323
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007324 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007325 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
7326 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007327 return 0;
7328}
7329
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007330Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007331 BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +00007332 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007333
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00007334 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
7335 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00007336 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00007337
Dan Gohmana119de82009-06-14 23:30:43 +00007338 // shl i32 X, 32 = 0 and srl i8 Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate
7339 // a signed shift.
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007340 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00007341 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00007342 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007343 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007344 else {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007345 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007346 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00007347 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007348 }
7349
7350 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
7351 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
7352 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
7353 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007354 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007355 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007356
7357 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
7358 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
7359 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
7360 return R;
7361 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
7362 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
7363 return NV;
7364
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007365 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
7366 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
7367 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
7368 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
7369 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
7370 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
7371 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
7372 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
7373 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
7374 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
7375 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007376 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007377 // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
7378 Value *NSh = Builder->CreateBinOp(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,I.getName());
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007379
7380 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
7381 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
7382 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
7383 // other xforms later if dead.
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00007384 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
7385 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007386 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
7387
7388 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
7389 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
7390 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
7391 // mask as appropriate.
7392 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
7393 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
7394 else {
7395 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
7396 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
7397 }
7398
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +00007399 // shift1 & 0x00FF
7400 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(NSh, ConstantInt::get(*Context, MaskV),
7401 TI->getName());
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007402
7403 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
7404 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
7405 }
7406 }
7407
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007408 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007409 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
7410 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
7411 Value *V1, *V2;
7412 ConstantInt *CC;
7413 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007414 default: break;
7415 case Instruction::Add:
7416 case Instruction::And:
7417 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007418 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007419 // These operators commute.
7420 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007421 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00007422 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1), m_Shr(m_Value(V1),
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007423 m_Specific(Op1)))) {
7424 Value *YS = // (Y << C)
7425 Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1, Op0BO->getName());
7426 // (X + (Y << C))
7427 Value *X = Builder->CreateBinOp(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
7428 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007429 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007430 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(*Context,
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00007431 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007432 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007433
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007434 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007435 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00007436 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007437 match(Op0BOOp1,
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00007438 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Specific(Op1)),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00007439 m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00007440 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007441 Value *YS = // (Y << C)
7442 Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
7443 Op0BO->getName());
7444 // X & (CC << C)
7445 Value *XM = Builder->CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
7446 V1->getName()+".mask");
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007447 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007448 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007449 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007450
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007451 // FALL THROUGH.
7452 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007453 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007454 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00007455 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0), m_Shr(m_Value(V1),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00007456 m_Specific(Op1)))) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007457 Value *YS = // (Y << C)
7458 Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1, Op0BO->getName());
7459 // (X + (Y << C))
7460 Value *X = Builder->CreateBinOp(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
7461 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007462 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007463 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(*Context,
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00007464 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007465 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007466
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00007467 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007468 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7469 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
7470 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00007471 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007472 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
7473 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007474 Value *YS = // (Y << C)
7475 Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1, Op0BO->getName());
7476 // X & (CC << C)
7477 Value *XM = Builder->CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
7478 V1->getName()+".mask");
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007479
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007480 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007481 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007482
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007483 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007484 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007485 }
7486
7487
7488 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
7489 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
7490 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
7491 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
7492 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
7493
7494 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007495 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00007496 case Instruction::Add:
7497 isValid = isLeftShift;
7498 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007499 case Instruction::Or:
7500 case Instruction::Xor:
7501 highBitSet = false;
7502 break;
7503 case Instruction::And:
7504 highBitSet = true;
7505 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007506 }
7507
7508 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
7509 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
7510 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
7511 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
7512 // operation.
7513 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00007514 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007515 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007516
7517 if (isValid) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007518 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007519
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007520 Value *NewShift =
7521 Builder->CreateBinOp(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007522 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007523
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007524 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007525 NewRHS);
7526 }
7527 }
7528 }
7529 }
7530
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007531 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007532 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
7533 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
7534 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007535
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007536 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007537 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00007538 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
7539 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007540 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
7541 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
7542 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007543
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007544 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007545
7546 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
7547
7548 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00007549 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007550 // If this is oversized composite shift, then unsigned shifts get 0, ashr
7551 // saturates.
7552 if (AmtSum >= TypeBits) {
7553 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007554 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007555 AmtSum = TypeBits-1; // Saturate to 31 for i32 ashr.
7556 }
7557
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007558 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007559 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007560 }
7561
7562 if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
7563 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007564 if (AmtSum >= TypeBits)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00007565 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007566
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007567 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007568 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007569 }
7570
7571 if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
7572 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007573 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007574 if (AmtSum >= TypeBits)
7575 AmtSum = TypeBits-1;
7576
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007577 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007578
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007579 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007580 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007581 }
7582
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007583 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
7584 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
7585 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
7586 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
7587 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007588 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007589 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007590 }
7591 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
7592 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00007593 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007594 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007595 }
7596 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
7597 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
7598 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
7599 // generators.
7600 const Type *SExtType = 0;
7601 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007602 case 1 :
7603 case 8 :
7604 case 16 :
7605 case 32 :
7606 case 64 :
7607 case 128:
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007608 SExtType = IntegerType::get(*Context, Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007609 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007610 default: break;
7611 }
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007612 if (SExtType)
7613 return new SExtInst(Builder->CreateTrunc(X, SExtType, "sext"), Ty);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007614 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
7615 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007616 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007617
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007618 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007619 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7620 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7621 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007622 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007623
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007624 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007625 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
7626 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007627 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007628
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007629 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007630 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7631 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007632 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007633
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00007634 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007635 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
7636 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007637 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007638
7639 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
7640 } else {
7641 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007642 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007643
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007644 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007645 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7646 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7647 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007648 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateBinOp(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
7649 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007650
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007651 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007652 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
7653 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007654 }
7655
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007656 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007657 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7658 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007659 Value *Shift = Builder->CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007660
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00007661 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00007662 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
7663 ConstantInt::get(*Context, Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007664 }
7665
7666 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007667 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007668 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007669 return 0;
7670}
7671
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007672
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007673/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
7674/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
7675/// X*Scale+Offset.
7676///
7677static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00007678 int &Offset, LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007679 assert(Val->getType() == Type::getInt32Ty(*Context) &&
7680 "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007681 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007682 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007683 Scale = 0;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007684 return ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007685 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
7686 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
7687 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7688 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
7689 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
7690 Offset = 0;
7691 return I->getOperand(0);
7692 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
7693 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
7694 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
7695 Offset = 0;
7696 return I->getOperand(0);
7697 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7698 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
7699 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
7700 unsigned SubScale;
7701 Value *SubVal =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007702 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale,
7703 Offset, Context);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007704 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
7705 Scale = SubScale;
7706 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007707 }
7708 }
7709 }
7710
7711 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
7712 Scale = 1;
7713 Offset = 0;
7714 return Val;
7715}
7716
7717
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007718/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
7719/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007720Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007721 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007722 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007723
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007724 BuilderTy AllocaBuilder(*Builder);
7725 AllocaBuilder.SetInsertPoint(AI.getParent(), &AI);
7726
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007727 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
7728 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00007729
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007730 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
7731 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
7732 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
7733 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
7734 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
7735
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007736 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +00007737 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: DCE: " << *User << '\n');
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00007738 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007739 }
7740 }
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00007741
7742 // This requires TargetData to get the alloca alignment and size information.
7743 if (!TD) return 0;
7744
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007745 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
7746 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
7747 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
7748 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007749
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007750 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
7751 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007752 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7753
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007754 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
7755 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
Dale Johannesena0a66372009-03-05 00:39:02 +00007756 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds. (A reference
7757 // from a dbg.declare doesn't count as a use for this purpose.)
7758 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && !hasOneUsePlusDeclare(&AI) &&
7759 CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007760
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00007761 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(AllocElTy);
7762 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007763 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007764
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007765 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
7766 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007767 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
7768 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007769 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007770 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale,
7771 ArrayOffset, Context);
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007772
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007773 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
7774 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007775 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
7776 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007777
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007778 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
7779 Value *Amt = 0;
7780 if (Scale == 1) {
7781 Amt = NumElements;
7782 } else {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007783 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Scale);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007784 // Insert before the alloca, not before the cast.
7785 Amt = AllocaBuilder.CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007786 }
7787
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007788 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00007789 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Offset, true);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007790 Amt = AllocaBuilder.CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007791 }
7792
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007793 AllocationInst *New;
7794 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007795 New = AllocaBuilder.CreateMalloc(CastElTy, Amt);
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007796 else
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007797 New = AllocaBuilder.CreateAlloca(CastElTy, Amt);
7798 New->setAlignment(AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007799 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007800
Dale Johannesena0a66372009-03-05 00:39:02 +00007801 // If the allocation has one real use plus a dbg.declare, just remove the
7802 // declare.
7803 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(&AI)) {
7804 EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
7805 }
7806 // If the allocation has multiple real uses, insert a cast and change all
7807 // things that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it
7808 // will die soon.
7809 else if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007810 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
7811 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00007812 Value *NewCast = AllocaBuilder.CreateBitCast(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007813 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
7814 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007815 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
7816}
7817
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007818/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007819/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
7820/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
7821/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
7822/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
7823///
7824/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
7825/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007826///
7827/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
7828/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
7829/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
7830/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
7831/// efficiently truncated.
7832///
7833/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
7834/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
7835/// the final result.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007836bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007837 unsigned CastOpc,
7838 int &NumCastsRemoved){
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007839 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007840 if (isa<Constant>(V))
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007841 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007842
7843 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007844 if (!I) return false;
7845
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007846 const Type *OrigTy = V->getType();
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007847
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007848 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
7849 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
7850 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
7851 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
7852 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
7853 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
7854 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
7855 // casts first.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007856 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007857 ++NumCastsRemoved;
7858 return true;
7859 }
7860 }
7861
7862 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
7863 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
7864 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
7865
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00007866 unsigned Opc = I->getOpcode();
7867 switch (Opc) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007868 case Instruction::Add:
7869 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007870 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007871 case Instruction::And:
7872 case Instruction::Or:
7873 case Instruction::Xor:
7874 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007875 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007876 NumCastsRemoved) &&
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007877 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007878 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007879
Eli Friedman070a9812009-07-13 22:46:01 +00007880 case Instruction::UDiv:
7881 case Instruction::URem: {
7882 // UDiv and URem can be truncated if all the truncated bits are zero.
7883 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
7884 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
7885 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth) {
7886 APInt Mask = APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth);
7887 if (MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0), Mask) &&
7888 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(1), Mask)) {
7889 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7890 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7891 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
7892 NumCastsRemoved);
7893 }
7894 }
7895 break;
7896 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007897 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007898 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
7899 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
7900 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007901 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
7902 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getScalarSizeInBits() &&
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007903 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007904 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007905 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007906 }
7907 break;
7908 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007909 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
7910 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
7911 // already zeros.
7912 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007913 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
7914 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007915 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007916 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007917 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
7918 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007919 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007920 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007921 }
7922 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007923 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007924 case Instruction::ZExt:
7925 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007926 case Instruction::Trunc:
7927 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00007928 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
7929 // of casts in the input.
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00007930 if (Opc == CastOpc)
7931 return true;
7932
7933 // sext (zext ty1), ty2 -> zext ty2
Evan Cheng661d9c32009-01-15 17:09:07 +00007934 if (CastOpc == Instruction::SExt && Opc == Instruction::ZExt)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007935 return true;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007936 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007937 case Instruction::Select: {
7938 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I);
7939 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getTrueValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007940 NumCastsRemoved) &&
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007941 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getFalseValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007942 NumCastsRemoved);
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007943 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007944 case Instruction::PHI: {
7945 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
7946 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7947 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
7948 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007949 NumCastsRemoved))
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007950 return false;
7951 return true;
7952 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007953 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007954 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7955 break;
7956 }
7957
7958 return false;
7959}
7960
7961/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
7962/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
7963/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007964Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007965 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007966 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00007967 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007968 isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007969
7970 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
7971 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00007972 Instruction *Res = 0;
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00007973 unsigned Opc = I->getOpcode();
7974 switch (Opc) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007975 case Instruction::Add:
7976 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00007977 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007978 case Instruction::And:
7979 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007980 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007981 case Instruction::AShr:
7982 case Instruction::LShr:
Eli Friedman070a9812009-07-13 22:46:01 +00007983 case Instruction::Shl:
7984 case Instruction::UDiv:
7985 case Instruction::URem: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007986 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007987 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00007988 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)Opc, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007989 break;
7990 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007991 case Instruction::Trunc:
7992 case Instruction::ZExt:
7993 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007994 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007995 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
7996 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007997 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
7998 return I->getOperand(0);
7999
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008000 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008001 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008002 Ty);
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008003 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00008004 case Instruction::Select: {
8005 Value *True = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
8006 Value *False = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(2), Ty, isSigned);
8007 Res = SelectInst::Create(I->getOperand(0), True, False);
8008 break;
8009 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008010 case Instruction::PHI: {
8011 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
8012 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
8013 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8014 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
8015 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
8016 }
8017 Res = NPN;
8018 break;
8019 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008020 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008021 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008022 llvm_unreachable("Unreachable!");
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008023 break;
8024 }
8025
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008026 Res->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008027 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
8028}
8029
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008030/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
8031Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00008032 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8033
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00008034 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008035 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00008036 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008037 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
8038 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
8039 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
8040 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008041 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00008042 }
8043 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00008044
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008045 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00008046 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
8047 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
8048 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008049
8050 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00008051 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
8052 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
8053 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00008054
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008055 return 0;
8056}
8057
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008058/// FindElementAtOffset - Given a type and a constant offset, determine whether
8059/// or not there is a sequence of GEP indices into the type that will land us at
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008060/// the specified offset. If so, fill them into NewIndices and return the
8061/// resultant element type, otherwise return null.
8062static const Type *FindElementAtOffset(const Type *Ty, int64_t Offset,
8063 SmallVectorImpl<Value*> &NewIndices,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008064 const TargetData *TD,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008065 LLVMContext *Context) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00008066 if (!TD) return 0;
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008067 if (!Ty->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008068
8069 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
8070 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
8071 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008072 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType(*Context);
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008073 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00008074 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(Ty)) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008075 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
Chris Lattner31a69cb2009-01-11 20:41:36 +00008076 Offset -= FirstIdx*TySize;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008077
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008078 // Handle hosts where % returns negative instead of values [0..TySize).
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008079 if (Offset < 0) {
8080 --FirstIdx;
8081 Offset += TySize;
8082 assert(Offset >= 0);
8083 }
8084 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize && "Out of range offset");
8085 }
8086
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008087 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008088
8089 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
8090 while (Offset) {
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008091 // Indexing into tail padding between struct/array elements.
8092 if (uint64_t(Offset*8) >= TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Ty))
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008093 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008094
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008095 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(Ty)) {
8096 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008097 assert(Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes() &&
8098 "Offset must stay within the indexed type");
8099
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008100 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008101 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Elt));
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008102
8103 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
8104 Ty = STy->getElementType(Elt);
Chris Lattner1c412d92009-01-11 20:23:52 +00008105 } else if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00008106 uint64_t EltSize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(AT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008107 assert(EltSize && "Cannot index into a zero-sized array");
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008108 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008109 Offset %= EltSize;
Chris Lattner1c412d92009-01-11 20:23:52 +00008110 Ty = AT->getElementType();
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008111 } else {
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008112 // Otherwise, we can't index into the middle of this atomic type, bail.
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008113 return 0;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008114 }
8115 }
8116
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008117 return Ty;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008118}
8119
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008120/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
8121Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
8122 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8123
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008124 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008125 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
8126 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008127 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
8128 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
8129 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
8130 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +00008131 Worklist.Add(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008132 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
8133 return &CI;
8134 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008135
8136 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
8137 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
8138 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
8139 // non-type-safe code.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00008140 if (TD && GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008141 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
8142 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008143 ConstantInt *OffsetV =
8144 cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008145 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
8146
8147 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
8148 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
8149 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
8150 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008151 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008152 if (FindElementAtOffset(GEPIdxTy, Offset, NewIndices, TD, Context)) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008153 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
8154 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
8155 // two.
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +00008156 Value *NGEP = cast<GEPOperator>(GEP)->isInBounds() ?
8157 Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(OrigBase,
8158 NewIndices.begin(), NewIndices.end()) :
8159 Builder->CreateGEP(OrigBase, NewIndices.begin(), NewIndices.end());
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008160 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008161
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008162 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
8163 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
8164 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
8165 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008166 }
8167 }
8168 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008169 }
8170
8171 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8172}
8173
Chris Lattnerddfa57b2009-04-08 05:41:03 +00008174/// isSafeIntegerType - Return true if this is a basic integer type, not a crazy
8175/// type like i42. We don't want to introduce operations on random non-legal
8176/// integer types where they don't already exist in the code. In the future,
8177/// we should consider making this based off target-data, so that 32-bit targets
8178/// won't get i64 operations etc.
8179static bool isSafeIntegerType(const Type *Ty) {
8180 switch (Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
8181 case 8:
8182 case 16:
8183 case 32:
8184 case 64:
8185 return true;
8186 default:
8187 return false;
8188 }
8189}
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008190
Eli Friedmaneb7f7a82009-07-13 20:58:59 +00008191/// commonIntCastTransforms - This function implements the common transforms
8192/// for trunc, zext, and sext.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008193Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
8194 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8195 return Result;
8196
8197 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8198 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8199 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008200 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
8201 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008202
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008203 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
8204 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00008205 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(CI))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008206 return &CI;
8207
8208 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
8209 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008210 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
8211 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008212 return 0;
8213
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008214 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008215 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008216 // Only do this if the dest type is a simple type, don't convert the
8217 // expression tree to something weird like i93 unless the source is also
8218 // strange.
8219 if ((isSafeIntegerType(DestTy->getScalarType()) ||
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008220 !isSafeIntegerType(SrcI->getType()->getScalarType())) &&
8221 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008222 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008223 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008224 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
8225 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
8226 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
8227 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008228 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008229 bool DoXForm = false;
8230 bool JustReplace = false;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008231 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
8232 default:
8233 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
8234 // get here because of the check above.
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008235 llvm_unreachable("Unknown cast type");
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008236 case Instruction::Trunc:
8237 DoXForm = true;
8238 break;
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008239 case Instruction::ZExt: {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008240 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008241 if (!DoXForm && 0) {
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008242 // If it's unnecessary to issue an AND to clear the high bits, it's
8243 // always profitable to do this xform.
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008244 Value *TryRes = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy, false);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008245 APInt Mask(APInt::getBitsSet(DestBitSize, SrcBitSize, DestBitSize));
8246 if (MaskedValueIsZero(TryRes, Mask))
8247 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, TryRes);
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008248
8249 if (Instruction *TryI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TryRes))
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008250 if (TryI->use_empty())
8251 EraseInstFromFunction(*TryI);
8252 }
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008253 break;
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008254 }
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008255 case Instruction::SExt: {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008256 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008257 if (!DoXForm && !isa<TruncInst>(SrcI) && 0) {
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008258 // If we do not have to emit the truncate + sext pair, then it's always
8259 // profitable to do this xform.
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008260 //
8261 // It's not safe to eliminate the trunc + sext pair if one of the
8262 // eliminated cast is a truncate. e.g.
8263 // t2 = trunc i32 t1 to i16
8264 // t3 = sext i16 t2 to i32
8265 // !=
8266 // i32 t1
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008267 Value *TryRes = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy, true);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008268 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(TryRes);
8269 if (NumSignBits > (DestBitSize - SrcBitSize))
8270 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, TryRes);
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008271
8272 if (Instruction *TryI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TryRes))
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008273 if (TryI->use_empty())
8274 EraseInstFromFunction(*TryI);
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008275 }
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008276 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008277 }
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008278 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008279
8280 if (DoXForm) {
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +00008281 DEBUG(errs() << "ICE: EvaluateInDifferentType converting expression type"
8282 " to avoid cast: " << CI);
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00008283 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
8284 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008285 if (JustReplace)
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008286 // Just replace this cast with the result.
8287 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008288
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008289 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
8290 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008291 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown cast type!");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008292 case Instruction::Trunc:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008293 // Just replace this cast with the result.
8294 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8295 case Instruction::ZExt: {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008296 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008297
8298 // If the high bits are already zero, just replace this cast with the
8299 // result.
8300 APInt Mask(APInt::getBitsSet(DestBitSize, SrcBitSize, DestBitSize));
8301 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Res, Mask))
8302 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8303
8304 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008305 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(*Context,
8306 APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize, SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008307 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008308 }
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008309 case Instruction::SExt: {
8310 // If the high bits are already filled with sign bit, just replace this
8311 // cast with the result.
8312 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Res);
8313 if (NumSignBits > (DestBitSize - SrcBitSize))
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008314 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8315
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008316 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008317 return new SExtInst(Builder->CreateTrunc(Res, Src->getType()), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008318 }
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008319 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008320 }
8321 }
8322
8323 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
8324 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
8325
8326 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
8327 case Instruction::Add:
8328 case Instruction::Mul:
8329 case Instruction::And:
8330 case Instruction::Or:
8331 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00008332 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008333 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
8334 // Don't insert two casts unless at least one can be eliminated.
8335 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008336 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008337 Value *Op0c = Builder->CreateTrunc(Op0, DestTy, Op0->getName());
8338 Value *Op1c = Builder->CreateTrunc(Op1, DestTy, Op1->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008339 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008340 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008341 }
8342 }
8343
8344 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
8345 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
8346 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00008347 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context) &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008348 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008349 Value *New = Builder->CreateZExt(Op0, DestTy, Op0->getName());
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008350 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008351 ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008352 }
8353 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008354
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008355 case Instruction::Shl: {
8356 // Canonicalize trunc inside shl, if we can.
8357 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1);
8358 if (CI && DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
8359 CI->getLimitedValue(DestBitSize) < DestBitSize) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008360 Value *Op0c = Builder->CreateTrunc(Op0, DestTy, Op0->getName());
8361 Value *Op1c = Builder->CreateTrunc(Op1, DestTy, Op1->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008362 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008363 }
8364 break;
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008365 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008366 }
8367 return 0;
8368}
8369
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008370Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00008371 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8372 return Result;
8373
8374 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8375 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008376 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
8377 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = Src->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008378
8379 // Canonicalize trunc x to i1 -> (icmp ne (and x, 1), 0)
Eli Friedman191a0ae2009-07-18 09:21:25 +00008380 if (DestBitWidth == 1) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008381 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(Src->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008382 Src = Builder->CreateAnd(Src, One, "tmp");
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00008383 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(Src->getType());
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +00008384 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Src, Zero);
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008385 }
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008386
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008387 // Optimize trunc(lshr(), c) to pull the shift through the truncate.
8388 ConstantInt *ShAmtV = 0;
8389 Value *ShiftOp = 0;
8390 if (Src->hasOneUse() &&
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00008391 match(Src, m_LShr(m_Value(ShiftOp), m_ConstantInt(ShAmtV)))) {
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008392 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
8393
8394 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
8395 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
8396 if (MaskedValueIsZero(ShiftOp, Mask)) {
8397 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00008398 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008399
8400 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
8401 // shift.
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008402 Value *V1 = Builder->CreateTrunc(ShiftOp, Ty, ShiftOp->getName());
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00008403 Value *V2 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(ShAmtV, Ty);
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008404 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00008405 }
8406 }
8407
8408 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008409}
8410
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008411/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
8412/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
8413Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
8414 bool DoXform) {
8415 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
8416 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
8417 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
8418 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
8419 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
8420
8421 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
8422 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
8423 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
8424 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
8425 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
8426
8427 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008428 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008429 In->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008430 In = Builder->CreateLShr(In, Sh, In->getName()+".lobit");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008431 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008432 In = Builder->CreateIntCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008433
8434 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008435 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008436 In = Builder->CreateXor(In, One, In->getName()+".not");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008437 }
8438
8439 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
8440 }
8441
8442
8443
8444 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
8445 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8446 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
8447 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8448 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
8449 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8450 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
8451 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8452 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
8453 // This only works for EQ and NE
8454 ICI->isEquality()) {
8455 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
8456 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
8457 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
8458 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
8459 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
8460
8461 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
8462 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
8463 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
8464
8465 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
8466 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
8467 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
8468 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008469 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt1Ty(*Context), isNE);
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00008470 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008471 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8472 }
8473
8474 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
8475 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
8476 if (ShiftAmt) {
8477 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
8478 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008479 In = Builder->CreateLShr(In, ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),ShiftAmt),
8480 In->getName()+".lobit");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008481 }
8482
8483 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008484 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008485 In = Builder->CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008486 }
8487
8488 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
8489 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
8490 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008491 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008492 }
8493 }
8494 }
8495
8496 return 0;
8497}
8498
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008499Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008500 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
8501 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8502 return Result;
8503
8504 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8505
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008506 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
8507 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
8508 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
8509 if (TruncInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
8510 // Get the sizes of the types involved. We know that the intermediate type
8511 // will be smaller than A or C, but don't know the relation between A and C.
8512 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008513 unsigned SrcSize = A->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8514 unsigned MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8515 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008516 // If we're actually extending zero bits, then if
8517 // SrcSize < DstSize: zext(a & mask)
8518 // SrcSize == DstSize: a & mask
8519 // SrcSize > DstSize: trunc(a) & mask
8520 if (SrcSize < DstSize) {
8521 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008522 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(A->getType(), AndValue);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008523 Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(A, AndConst, CSrc->getName()+".mask");
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008524 return new ZExtInst(And, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008525 }
8526
8527 if (SrcSize == DstSize) {
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008528 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008529 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, ConstantInt::get(A->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008530 AndValue));
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008531 }
8532 if (SrcSize > DstSize) {
8533 Value *Trunc = Builder->CreateTrunc(A, CI.getType(), "tmp");
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008534 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DstSize, MidSize));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008535 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Trunc,
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008536 ConstantInt::get(Trunc->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008537 AndValue));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008538 }
8539 }
8540
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008541 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
8542 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00008543
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008544 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
8545 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
8546 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
8547 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
8548 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
8549 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
8550 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
8551 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
8552 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008553 Value *LCast = Builder->CreateZExt(LHS, CI.getType(), LHS->getName());
8554 Value *RCast = Builder->CreateZExt(RHS, CI.getType(), RHS->getName());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008555 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00008556 }
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008557 }
8558
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008559 // zext(trunc(t) & C) -> (t & zext(C)).
Dan Gohmana392c782009-06-17 23:17:05 +00008560 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && SrcI->hasOneUse())
8561 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1)))
8562 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0))) {
8563 Value *TI0 = TI->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008564 if (TI0->getType() == CI.getType())
8565 return
8566 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(TI0,
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00008567 ConstantExpr::getZExt(C, CI.getType()));
Dan Gohmana392c782009-06-17 23:17:05 +00008568 }
8569
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008570 // zext((trunc(t) & C) ^ C) -> ((t & zext(C)) ^ zext(C)).
8571 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor && SrcI->hasOneUse())
8572 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1)))
8573 if (BinaryOperator *And = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI->getOperand(0)))
8574 if (And->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && And->hasOneUse() &&
8575 And->getOperand(1) == C)
8576 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(And->getOperand(0))) {
8577 Value *TI0 = TI->getOperand(0);
8578 if (TI0->getType() == CI.getType()) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00008579 Constant *ZC = ConstantExpr::getZExt(C, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008580 Value *NewAnd = Builder->CreateAnd(TI0, ZC, "tmp");
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008581 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, ZC);
8582 }
8583 }
8584
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008585 return 0;
8586}
8587
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008588Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008589 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8590 return I;
8591
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008592 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8593
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008594 // Canonicalize sign-extend from i1 to a select.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008595 if (Src->getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context))
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008596 return SelectInst::Create(Src,
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00008597 Constant::getAllOnesValue(CI.getType()),
8598 Constant::getNullValue(CI.getType()));
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008599
8600 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
8601 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
Dan Gohmanca178902009-07-17 20:47:02 +00008602 if (Operator::getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008603 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008604 unsigned OpBits = Op->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8605 unsigned MidBits = Src->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8606 unsigned DestBits = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008607 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
8608
8609 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
8610 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
8611 // bits, it is already ready.
8612 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
8613 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
8614 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
8615 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
8616 // bits, just sext from i32.
8617 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8618 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8619 } else {
8620 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
8621 // bits, just truncate to i32.
8622 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8623 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8624 }
8625 }
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008626
8627 // If the input is a shl/ashr pair of a same constant, then this is a sign
8628 // extension from a smaller value. If we could trust arbitrary bitwidth
8629 // integers, we could turn this into a truncate to the smaller bit and then
8630 // use a sext for the whole extension. Since we don't, look deeper and check
8631 // for a truncate. If the source and dest are the same type, eliminate the
8632 // trunc and extend and just do shifts. For example, turn:
8633 // %a = trunc i32 %i to i8
8634 // %b = shl i8 %a, 6
8635 // %c = ashr i8 %b, 6
8636 // %d = sext i8 %c to i32
8637 // into:
8638 // %a = shl i32 %i, 30
8639 // %d = ashr i32 %a, 30
8640 Value *A = 0;
8641 ConstantInt *BA = 0, *CA = 0;
8642 if (match(Src, m_AShr(m_Shl(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(BA)),
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00008643 m_ConstantInt(CA))) &&
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008644 BA == CA && isa<TruncInst>(A)) {
8645 Value *I = cast<TruncInst>(A)->getOperand(0);
8646 if (I->getType() == CI.getType()) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008647 unsigned MidSize = Src->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8648 unsigned SrcDstSize = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008649 unsigned ShAmt = CA->getZExtValue()+SrcDstSize-MidSize;
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008650 Constant *ShAmtV = ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), ShAmt);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008651 I = Builder->CreateShl(I, ShAmtV, CI.getName());
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008652 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(I, ShAmtV);
8653 }
8654 }
8655
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008656 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008657}
8658
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008659/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
8660/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008661static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008662 LLVMContext *Context) {
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008663 bool losesInfo;
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008664 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008665 (void)F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &losesInfo);
8666 if (!losesInfo)
Owen Anderson6f83c9c2009-07-27 20:59:43 +00008667 return ConstantFP::get(*Context, F);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008668 return 0;
8669}
8670
8671/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
8672/// through it until we get the source value.
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008673static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V, LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008674 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
8675 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008676 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0), Context);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008677
8678 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
8679 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
8680 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
8681 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008682 if (CFP->getType() == Type::getPPC_FP128Ty(*Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008683 return V; // No constant folding of this.
8684 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008685 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle, Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008686 return V;
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008687 if (CFP->getType() == Type::getDoubleTy(*Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008688 return V; // Won't shrink.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008689 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble, Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008690 return V;
8691 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
8692 }
8693
8694 return V;
8695}
8696
8697Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
8698 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8699 return I;
8700
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00008701 // If we have fptrunc(fadd (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008702 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00008703 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to fadd/fsub/fmul/fdiv as well as
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008704 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
8705 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
8706 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
8707 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
8708 default: break;
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00008709 case Instruction::FAdd:
8710 case Instruction::FSub:
8711 case Instruction::FMul:
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008712 case Instruction::FDiv:
8713 case Instruction::FRem:
8714 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008715 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0), Context);
8716 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1), Context);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008717 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
8718 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008719 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008720 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
8721 // the cast, do this xform.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008722 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
8723 RHSTrunc->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008724 LHSTrunc = Builder->CreateFPExt(LHSTrunc, CI.getType());
8725 RHSTrunc = Builder->CreateFPExt(RHSTrunc, CI.getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008726 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008727 }
8728 }
8729 break;
8730 }
8731 }
8732 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008733}
8734
8735Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
8736 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8737}
8738
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008739Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008740 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8741 if (OpI == 0)
8742 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8743
8744 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X
8745 // fptoui(sitofp(X)) --> X
8746 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8747 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8748 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8749 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8750 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8751 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008752 (int)FI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008753 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8754 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008755
8756 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008757}
8758
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008759Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008760 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8761 if (OpI == 0)
8762 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8763
8764 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X
8765 // fptosi(uitofp(X)) --> X
8766 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8767 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8768 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8769 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8770 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8771 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008772 (int)FI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() <=
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008773 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8774 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008775
8776 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008777}
8778
8779Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8780 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8781}
8782
8783Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8784 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8785}
8786
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008787Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(PtrToIntInst &CI) {
8788 // If the destination integer type is smaller than the intptr_t type for
8789 // this target, do a ptrtoint to intptr_t then do a trunc. This allows the
8790 // trunc to be exposed to other transforms. Don't do this for extending
8791 // ptrtoint's, because we don't know if the target sign or zero extends its
8792 // pointers.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00008793 if (TD &&
8794 CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() < TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008795 Value *P = Builder->CreatePtrToInt(CI.getOperand(0),
8796 TD->getIntPtrType(CI.getContext()),
8797 "tmp");
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008798 return new TruncInst(P, CI.getType());
8799 }
8800
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008801 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008802}
8803
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008804Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008805 // If the source integer type is larger than the intptr_t type for
8806 // this target, do a trunc to the intptr_t type, then inttoptr of it. This
8807 // allows the trunc to be exposed to other transforms. Don't do this for
8808 // extending inttoptr's, because we don't know if the target sign or zero
8809 // extends to pointers.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008810 if (TD && CI.getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() >
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008811 TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008812 Value *P = Builder->CreateTrunc(CI.getOperand(0),
8813 TD->getIntPtrType(CI.getContext()), "tmp");
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008814 return new IntToPtrInst(P, CI.getType());
8815 }
8816
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008817 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8818 return I;
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008819
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008820 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008821}
8822
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008823Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008824 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
8825 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
8826 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8827 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8828 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
8829
Eli Friedman7e25d452009-07-13 20:53:00 +00008830 if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008831 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
8832 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008833 } else {
8834 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8835 return Result;
8836 }
8837
8838
8839 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
8840 // be replaced by the operand.
8841 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
8842 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
8843
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008844 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008845 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
8846 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
8847 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
8848
Nate Begeman83ad90a2008-03-31 00:22:16 +00008849 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
8850 // required for changing types.
8851 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
8852 return 0;
8853
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +00008854 // If we are casting a alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008855 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +00008856 // There is no need to modify malloc calls because it is their bitcast that
8857 // needs to be cleaned up.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008858 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
8859 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
8860 return V;
8861
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00008862 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
8863 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008864 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00008865 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008866 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
8867 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
8868 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
8869 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
8870 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
8871 ++NumZeros;
8872 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00008873
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008874 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
8875 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
8876 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +00008877 return GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
8878 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00008879 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008880 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00008881
Eli Friedman2451a642009-07-18 23:06:53 +00008882 if (const VectorType *DestVTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(DestTy)) {
8883 if (DestVTy->getNumElements() == 1) {
8884 if (!isa<VectorType>(SrcTy)) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008885 Value *Elem = Builder->CreateBitCast(Src, DestVTy->getElementType());
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00008886 return InsertElementInst::Create(UndefValue::get(DestTy), Elem,
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008887 Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Eli Friedman2451a642009-07-18 23:06:53 +00008888 }
8889 // FIXME: Canonicalize bitcast(insertelement) -> insertelement(bitcast)
8890 }
8891 }
8892
8893 if (const VectorType *SrcVTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(SrcTy)) {
8894 if (SrcVTy->getNumElements() == 1) {
8895 if (!isa<VectorType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00008896 Value *Elem =
8897 Builder->CreateExtractElement(Src,
8898 Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Eli Friedman2451a642009-07-18 23:06:53 +00008899 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Elem, DestTy);
8900 }
8901 }
8902 }
8903
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008904 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
8905 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
8906 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
8907 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008908 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00008909 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
8910 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() &&
8911 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() ==
8912 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008913 CastInst *Tmp;
8914 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
8915 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
8916 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
8917 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
8918 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
8919 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
8920 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +00008921 Value *LHS = Builder->CreateBitCast(SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy);
8922 Value *RHS = Builder->CreateBitCast(SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008923 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
8924 // know the vector types match #elts.
8925 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00008926 }
8927 }
8928 }
8929 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00008930 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008931}
8932
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008933/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
8934/// %C = or %A, %B
8935/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
8936/// into:
8937/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
8938/// %D = or %A, %C
8939///
8940/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
8941/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
8942/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
8943///
8944static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
8945 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8946 case Instruction::Add:
8947 case Instruction::Mul:
8948 case Instruction::And:
8949 case Instruction::Or:
8950 case Instruction::Xor:
8951 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
8952 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
8953 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008954 case Instruction::LShr:
8955 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008956 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008957 default:
8958 return 0; // Cannot fold
8959 }
8960}
8961
8962/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
8963/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008964static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008965 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008966 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008967 default: llvm_unreachable("This cannot happen!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008968 case Instruction::Add:
8969 case Instruction::Sub:
8970 case Instruction::Or:
8971 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008972 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008973 case Instruction::LShr:
8974 case Instruction::AShr:
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00008975 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008976 case Instruction::And:
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00008977 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008978 case Instruction::Mul:
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00008979 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008980 }
8981}
8982
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008983/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
8984/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
8985Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
8986 Instruction *FI) {
8987 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
8988 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
8989 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008990 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008991 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
8992 return 0;
8993 } else {
8994 return 0; // unknown unary op.
8995 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008996
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008997 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008998 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
Eric Christophera66297a2009-07-25 02:45:27 +00008999 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009000 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009001 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009002 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009003 }
9004
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009005 // Only handle binary operators here.
9006 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009007 return 0;
9008
9009 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
9010 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
9011 bool MatchIsOpZero;
9012 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
9013 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
9014 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
9015 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
9016 MatchIsOpZero = true;
9017 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
9018 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
9019 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
9020 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
9021 MatchIsOpZero = false;
9022 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
9023 return 0;
9024 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
9025 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
9026 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
9027 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
9028 MatchIsOpZero = true;
9029 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
9030 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
9031 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
9032 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
9033 MatchIsOpZero = true;
9034 } else {
9035 return 0;
9036 }
9037
9038 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009039 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
9040 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009041 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
9042
9043 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
9044 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009045 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009046 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009047 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009048 }
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009049 llvm_unreachable("Shouldn't get here");
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00009050 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009051}
9052
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009053static bool isSelect01(Constant *C1, Constant *C2) {
9054 ConstantInt *C1I = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C1);
9055 if (!C1I)
9056 return false;
9057 ConstantInt *C2I = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C2);
9058 if (!C2I)
9059 return false;
9060 return (C1I->isZero() || C1I->isOne()) && (C2I->isZero() || C2I->isOne());
9061}
9062
9063/// FoldSelectIntoOp - Try fold the select into one of the operands to
9064/// facilitate further optimization.
9065Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectIntoOp(SelectInst &SI, Value *TrueVal,
9066 Value *FalseVal) {
9067 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
9068 // transformation we are doing here.
9069 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal)) {
9070 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
9071 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal)) {
9072 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
9073 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
9074 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
9075 OpToFold = 1;
9076 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
9077 OpToFold = 2;
9078 }
9079
9080 if (OpToFold) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009081 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI, Context);
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009082 Value *OOp = TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold);
9083 // Avoid creating select between 2 constants unless it's selecting
9084 // between 0 and 1.
9085 if (!isa<Constant>(OOp) || isSelect01(C, cast<Constant>(OOp))) {
9086 Instruction *NewSel = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OOp, C);
9087 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
9088 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
9089 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
9090 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009091 llvm_unreachable("Unknown instruction!!");
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009092 }
9093 }
9094 }
9095 }
9096 }
9097
9098 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal)) {
9099 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
9100 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal)) {
9101 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
9102 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
9103 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
9104 OpToFold = 1;
9105 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
9106 OpToFold = 2;
9107 }
9108
9109 if (OpToFold) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009110 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI, Context);
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009111 Value *OOp = FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold);
9112 // Avoid creating select between 2 constants unless it's selecting
9113 // between 0 and 1.
9114 if (!isa<Constant>(OOp) || isSelect01(C, cast<Constant>(OOp))) {
9115 Instruction *NewSel = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C, OOp);
9116 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
9117 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
9118 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
9119 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009120 llvm_unreachable("Unknown instruction!!");
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009121 }
9122 }
9123 }
9124 }
9125 }
9126
9127 return 0;
9128}
9129
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009130/// visitSelectInstWithICmp - Visit a SelectInst that has an
9131/// ICmpInst as its first operand.
9132///
9133Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI,
9134 ICmpInst *ICI) {
9135 bool Changed = false;
9136 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
9137 Value *CmpLHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
9138 Value *CmpRHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
9139 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
9140 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
9141
9142 // Check cases where the comparison is with a constant that
9143 // can be adjusted to fit the min/max idiom. We may edit ICI in
9144 // place here, so make sure the select is the only user.
9145 if (ICI->hasOneUse())
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009146 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CmpRHS)) {
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009147 switch (Pred) {
9148 default: break;
9149 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
9150 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: {
9151 // X < MIN ? T : F --> F
9152 if (CI->isMinValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT))
9153 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9154 // X < C ? X : C-1 --> X > C-1 ? C-1 : X
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00009155 Constant *AdjustedRHS = SubOne(CI);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009156 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
9157 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
9158 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
9159 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
9160 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
9161 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
9162 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
9163 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
9164 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
9165 Changed = true;
9166 }
9167 break;
9168 }
9169 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
9170 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: {
9171 // X > MAX ? T : F --> F
9172 if (CI->isMaxValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT))
9173 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9174 // X > C ? X : C+1 --> X < C+1 ? C+1 : X
Dan Gohman186a6362009-08-12 16:04:34 +00009175 Constant *AdjustedRHS = AddOne(CI);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009176 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
9177 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
9178 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
9179 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
9180 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
9181 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
9182 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
9183 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
9184 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
9185 Changed = true;
9186 }
9187 break;
9188 }
9189 }
9190
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009191 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
9192 // (x >s -1) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009193 CmpInst::Predicate Pred = CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009194 if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt<-1>()) &&
9195 match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt<0>()))
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009196 Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009197 else if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt<0>()) &&
9198 match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt<-1>()))
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009199 Pred = CmpInst::getInversePredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
9200
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009201 if (Pred != CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE) {
9202 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
9203 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
9204 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
9205 const APInt &Op1CV = CI->getValue();
9206
9207 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
9208 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
9209 if ((Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009210 (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009211 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00009212 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00009213 In->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits()-1);
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009214 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
Eric Christophera66297a2009-07-25 02:45:27 +00009215 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009216 *ICI);
Dan Gohman21440ac2008-11-02 00:17:33 +00009217 if (In->getType() != SI.getType())
9218 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, SI.getType(),
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009219 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", ICI);
9220
9221 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009222 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(In,
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009223 In->getName()+".not"), *ICI);
9224
9225 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, In);
9226 }
9227 }
9228 }
9229
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009230 if (CmpLHS == TrueVal && CmpRHS == FalseVal) {
9231 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
9232 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
9233 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9234 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
9235 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
9236 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9237 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
9238
9239 } else if (CmpLHS == FalseVal && CmpRHS == TrueVal) {
9240 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
9241 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
9242 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9243 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
9244 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
9245 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9246 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
9247 }
9248
9249 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer ABS
9250
9251 return Changed ? &SI : 0;
9252}
9253
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00009254/// isDefinedInBB - Return true if the value is an instruction defined in the
9255/// specified basicblock.
9256static bool isDefinedInBB(const Value *V, const BasicBlock *BB) {
9257 const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
9258 return I != 0 && I->getParent() == BB;
9259}
9260
9261
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009262Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00009263 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
9264 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
9265 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
9266
9267 // select true, X, Y -> X
9268 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009269 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00009270 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00009271
9272 // select C, X, X -> X
9273 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
9274 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9275
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009276 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
9277 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9278 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
9279 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9280 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
9281 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
9282 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9283 else
9284 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9285 }
9286
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00009287 if (SI.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(*Context)) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00009288 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00009289 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009290 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009291 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009292 } else {
9293 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
9294 Value *NotCond =
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009295 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009296 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009297 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009298 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00009299 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00009300 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009301 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009302 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009303 } else {
9304 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
9305 Value *NotCond =
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009306 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009307 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009308 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009309 }
9310 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00009311
9312 // select a, b, a -> a&b
9313 // select a, a, b -> a|b
9314 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009315 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00009316 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009317 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009318 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009319
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00009320 // Selecting between two integer constants?
9321 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
9322 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009323 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009324 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009325 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009326 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009327 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00009328 Value *NotCond =
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009329 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00009330 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009331 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00009332 }
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009333
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009334 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00009335 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009336 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00009337 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
9338 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009339 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00009340 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009341 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
9342 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
9343 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009344 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
9345 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
9346 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009347 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
9348 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009349 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
9350 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009351 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009352 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009353 Value *V = ICA;
9354 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009355 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009356 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
9357 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
9358 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00009359 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00009360 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009361
9362 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009363 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
9364 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009365 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00009366 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
9367 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
9368 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
9369 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
9370 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
9371 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
9372 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
9373 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
9374 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009375 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00009376 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009377 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009378 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009379 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009380 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009381
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009382 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009383 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00009384 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
9385 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
9386 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
9387 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
9388 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
9389 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
9390 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
9391 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
9392 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
9393 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9394 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009395 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009396 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
9397 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009398 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009399 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009400 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect ABS
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009401 }
9402
9403 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009404 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal))
9405 if (Instruction *Result = visitSelectInstWithICmp(SI, ICI))
9406 return Result;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009407
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009408 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
9409 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
9410 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009411 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
9412
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009413 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
9414 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
9415 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
9416 return IV;
9417
9418 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
9419 // even legal for FP.
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00009420 if ((TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
9421 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) ||
9422 (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FSub &&
9423 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd)) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009424 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00009425 } else if ((FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
9426 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) ||
9427 (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FSub &&
9428 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd)) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009429 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
9430 }
9431
9432 if (AddOp) {
9433 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
9434 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
9435 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
9436 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
9437 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
9438 }
9439
9440 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009441 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
9442 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
9443 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
9444 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +00009445 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009446 } else {
9447 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +00009448 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1),
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00009449 "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009450 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009451
9452 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
9453 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
9454 if (AddOp != TI)
9455 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
9456 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009457 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
9458 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009459
9460 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009461 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009462 }
9463 }
9464 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009465
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009466 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00009467 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009468 Instruction *FoldI = FoldSelectIntoOp(SI, TrueVal, FalseVal);
9469 if (FoldI)
9470 return FoldI;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009471 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00009472
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00009473 // See if we can fold the select into a phi node. The true/false values have
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00009474 // to be live in the predecessor blocks. If they are instructions in SI's
9475 // block, we can't map to the predecessor.
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00009476 if (isa<PHINode>(SI.getCondition()) &&
Chris Lattnerc6df8f42009-09-27 20:18:49 +00009477 (!isDefinedInBB(SI.getTrueValue(), SI.getParent()) ||
9478 isa<PHINode>(SI.getTrueValue())) &&
9479 (!isDefinedInBB(SI.getFalseValue(), SI.getParent()) ||
9480 isa<PHINode>(SI.getFalseValue())))
Chris Lattner5d1704d2009-09-27 19:57:57 +00009481 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(SI))
9482 return NV;
9483
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00009484 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
9485 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
9486 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
9487 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
9488 return &SI;
9489 }
9490
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009491 return 0;
9492}
9493
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009494/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
9495/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
9496/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
9497/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
9498/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
9499///
9500static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
9501 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009502
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009503 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
9504 if (!U) return Align;
9505
Dan Gohmanca178902009-07-17 20:47:02 +00009506 switch (Operator::getOpcode(U)) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009507 default: break;
9508 case Instruction::BitCast:
9509 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
9510 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009511 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
9512 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greif52ed3632008-06-12 21:51:29 +00009513 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009514 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
9515 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009516 AllZeroOperands = false;
9517 break;
9518 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009519
9520 if (AllZeroOperands) {
9521 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009522 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009523 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009524 break;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009525 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009526 }
9527
9528 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
9529 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
9530 // of the global.
9531 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
Dan Gohmanecd0fb52009-02-16 23:02:21 +00009532 if (GV->getAlignment() >= PrefAlign)
9533 Align = GV->getAlignment();
9534 else {
9535 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
9536 Align = PrefAlign;
9537 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009538 }
Chris Lattner42ebefa2009-09-27 21:42:46 +00009539 } else if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(V)) {
9540 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up.
9541 if (AI->getAlignment() >= PrefAlign)
9542 Align = AI->getAlignment();
9543 else {
9544 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
9545 Align = PrefAlign;
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009546 }
9547 }
9548
9549 return Align;
9550}
9551
9552/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
9553/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
9554/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
9555/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
9556unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
9557 unsigned PrefAlign) {
9558 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
9559 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
9560 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
9561 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
9562 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
9563 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
9564 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
9565
9566 if (PrefAlign > Align)
9567 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
9568
9569 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
9570 return Align;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009571}
9572
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009573Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009574 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohmanbc989d42009-02-22 18:06:32 +00009575 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009576 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
Chris Lattnerdfe964c2009-03-08 03:59:00 +00009577 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment();
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009578
9579 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00009580 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(MI->getAlignmentType(),
Owen Andersona547b472009-07-09 18:36:20 +00009581 MinAlign, false));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009582 return MI;
9583 }
9584
9585 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
9586 // load/store.
9587 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
9588 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
9589
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009590 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
9591 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
9592 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
9593 // case.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009594 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009595 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
9596
9597 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009598 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009599
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009600 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009601 Type *NewPtrTy =
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00009602 PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(*Context, Size<<3));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009603
9604 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
9605 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
9606 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
9607 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
9608 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
9609 // integer datatype.
9610 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
9611 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00009612 if (TD && SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009613 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
9614 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009615 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009616 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
9617 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
9618 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
9619 else
9620 break;
9621 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
9622 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
9623 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
9624 else
9625 break;
9626 } else
9627 break;
9628 }
9629
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009630 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +00009631 NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(SrcETy);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009632 }
9633 }
9634
9635
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009636 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
9637 // infer, use it.
9638 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
9639 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
9640
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00009641 Value *Src = Builder->CreateBitCast(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy);
9642 Value *Dest = Builder->CreateBitCast(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009643 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
9644 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
9645 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
9646
9647 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00009648 MI->setOperand(3, Constant::getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009649 return MI;
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009650}
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009651
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009652Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
9653 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
Chris Lattnerdfe964c2009-03-08 03:59:00 +00009654 if (MI->getAlignment() < Alignment) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00009655 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(MI->getAlignmentType(),
Owen Andersona547b472009-07-09 18:36:20 +00009656 Alignment, false));
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009657 return MI;
9658 }
9659
9660 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
9661 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
9662 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00009663 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::getInt8Ty(*Context))
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009664 return 0;
9665 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerdfe964c2009-03-08 03:59:00 +00009666 Alignment = MI->getAlignment();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009667
9668 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
9669 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
9670
9671 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
9672 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +00009673 const Type *ITy = IntegerType::get(*Context, Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009674
9675 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00009676 Dest = Builder->CreateBitCast(Dest, PointerType::getUnqual(ITy));
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009677
9678 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
9679 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
9680
9681 // Extract the fill value and store.
9682 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +00009683 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(ConstantInt::get(ITy, Fill),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009684 Dest, false, Alignment), *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009685
9686 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +00009687 MI->setLength(Constant::getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009688 return MI;
9689 }
9690
9691 return 0;
9692}
9693
9694
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009695/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
9696/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
9697/// the heavy lifting.
9698///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009699Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattneraab6ec42009-05-13 17:39:14 +00009700 // If the caller function is nounwind, mark the call as nounwind, even if the
9701 // callee isn't.
9702 if (CI.getParent()->getParent()->doesNotThrow() &&
9703 !CI.doesNotThrow()) {
9704 CI.setDoesNotThrow();
9705 return &CI;
9706 }
9707
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009708 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
9709 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
9710
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009711 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
9712 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009713 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009714 bool Changed = false;
9715
9716 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
9717 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
9718 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9719
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009720 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009721 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009722 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
9723 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
9724 // alignment is sufficient.
9725 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009726 }
9727
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009728 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
9729 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
9730 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009731 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009732 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
9733 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
9734 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner824b9582008-11-21 16:42:48 +00009735 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy;
9736 const Type *Tys[1];
9737 Tys[0] = CI.getOperand(3)->getType();
9738 CI.setOperand(0,
9739 Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID, Tys, 1));
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009740 Changed = true;
9741 }
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +00009742
9743 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
9744 if (MMI->getSource() == MMI->getDest())
9745 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009746 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009747
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009748 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
9749 // set, update the alignment.
Chris Lattner3ce5e882009-03-08 03:37:16 +00009750 if (isa<MemTransferInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009751 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
9752 return I;
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009753 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
9754 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
9755 return I;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009756 }
9757
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009758 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009759 }
9760
9761 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
9762 default: break;
9763 case Intrinsic::bswap:
9764 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
9765 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
9766 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
9767 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
9768 break;
9769 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
9770 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
9771 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
9772 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
9773 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
9774 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9775 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9776 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00009777 Value *Ptr = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(1),
9778 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()));
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009779 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009780 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009781 break;
9782 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
9783 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
9784 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9785 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
9786 const Type *OpPtrTy =
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +00009787 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00009788 Value *Ptr = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009789 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
9790 }
9791 break;
9792 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
9793 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
9794 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009795 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9796 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9797 const Type *OpPtrTy =
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +00009798 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00009799 Value *Ptr = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009800 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
9801 }
9802 break;
9803
9804 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
9805 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
9806 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00009807 unsigned VWidth =
9808 cast<VectorType>(II->getOperand(1)->getType())->getNumElements();
9809 APInt DemandedElts(VWidth, 1);
9810 APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
9811 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009812 UndefElts)) {
9813 II->setOperand(1, V);
9814 return II;
9815 }
9816 break;
9817 }
9818
9819 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
9820 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
9821 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
9822 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009823
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009824 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
9825 bool AllEltsOk = true;
9826 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
9827 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
9828 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
9829 AllEltsOk = false;
9830 break;
9831 }
9832 }
9833
9834 if (AllEltsOk) {
9835 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +00009836 Value *Op0 = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(1), Mask->getType());
9837 Value *Op1 = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(2), Mask->getType());
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00009838 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009839
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009840 // Only extract each element once.
9841 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
9842 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
9843
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009844 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009845 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
9846 continue;
9847 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
9848 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
9849
9850 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00009851 ExtractedElts[Idx] =
9852 Builder->CreateExtractElement(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1,
9853 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Idx&15, false),
9854 "tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009855 }
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009856
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009857 // Insert this value into the result vector.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +00009858 Result = Builder->CreateInsertElement(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
9859 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i, false),
9860 "tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009861 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009862 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009863 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009864 }
9865 break;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009866
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009867 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
9868 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
9869 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
9870 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
9871 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
9872 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
9873 if (&*++BI == II)
9874 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009875 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009876 }
9877
9878 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
9879 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
9880 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
9881 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
9882 bool CannotRemove = false;
9883 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +00009884 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI) || isMalloc(BI)) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009885 CannotRemove = true;
9886 break;
9887 }
Chris Lattneraa0bf522008-06-25 05:59:28 +00009888 if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
9889 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
9890 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
9891 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
9892 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9893 // Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
9894 } else {
9895 // If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
9896 // restore.
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +00009897 CannotRemove = true;
9898 break;
9899 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009900 }
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009901 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009902
9903 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
9904 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
9905 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
9906 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9907 break;
9908 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009909 }
9910
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009911 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009912}
9913
9914// InvokeInst simplification
9915//
9916Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009917 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009918}
9919
Dale Johannesenda30ccb2008-04-25 21:16:07 +00009920/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
9921/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009922static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
9923 const CastInst * const CI,
9924 const TargetData * const TD,
9925 const int ix) {
9926 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
9927 return false;
9928
9929 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
9930 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
9931 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009932 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, Attribute::ByVal))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009933 return true;
9934
9935 const Type* SrcTy =
9936 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
9937 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
9938 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
9939 return false;
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00009940 if (!TD || TD->getTypeAllocSize(SrcTy) != TD->getTypeAllocSize(DstTy))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009941 return false;
9942 return true;
9943}
9944
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009945// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
9946//
9947Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009948 bool Changed = false;
9949
9950 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
9951 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009952 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
9953
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009954 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009955
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009956 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
9957 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
9958 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
9959 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
9960 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00009961 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context),
Duncan Sandsac53a0b2009-10-06 15:40:36 +00009962 UndefValue::get(Type::getInt1PtrTy(*Context)),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009963 OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009964 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00009965 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009966 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
9967 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
9968 return 0;
9969 }
9970
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009971 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
9972 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
9973 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
9974 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00009975 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context),
Duncan Sandsac53a0b2009-10-06 15:40:36 +00009976 UndefValue::get(Type::getInt1PtrTy(*Context)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009977 CS.getInstruction());
9978
9979 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
9980 CS.getInstruction()->
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +00009981 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009982
9983 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
9984 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009985 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +00009986 ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009987 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009988 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
9989 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009990
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009991 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
9992 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
9993 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
9994 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
9995
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009996 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9997 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
9998 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen63e7eb42008-04-23 01:03:05 +00009999 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010000 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
10001 // the call.
10002 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +000010003 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
10004 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
10005 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
10006 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
10007 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010008 }
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +000010009 }
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010010 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010011
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +000010012 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +000010013 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +000010014 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +000010015 Changed = true;
10016 }
10017
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010018 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +000010019}
10020
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010021// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
10022// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
10023//
10024bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
10025 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
10026 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010027 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
10028 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010029 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +000010030 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010031 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010032 const AttrListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getAttributes();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010033
10034 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
10035 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
10036 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
10037 //
10038 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
10039 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010040 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010041
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010042 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Patel75e6f022008-03-11 18:04:06 +000010043 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
10044
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010045 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010046 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000010047 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010048 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
10049 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000010050 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || !TD ||
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010051 OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext())) &&
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000010052 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || !TD ||
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010053 NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext()))))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +000010054 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010055
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010056 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010057 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010058 NewRetTy != Type::getVoidTy(*Context) && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010059 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
10060
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010061 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010062 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010063 if (RAttrs & Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sands6c3470e2008-01-07 17:16:06 +000010064 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
10065 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010066
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010067 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
10068 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
10069 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
10070 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
10071 if (!Caller->use_empty())
10072 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
10073 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
10074 UI != E; ++UI)
10075 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
10076 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +000010077 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010078 return false;
10079 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010080
10081 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
10082 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010083
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010084 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
10085 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
10086 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +000010087 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010088
10089 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010090 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
10091
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010092 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1)
10093 & Attribute::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010094 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010095
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010096 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
10097 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +000010098 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010099 (TD && ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) ||
10100 ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext())) &&
10101 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) ||
10102 ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext()))));
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010103 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010104 }
10105
10106 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010107 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010108 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010109
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010110 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
10111 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010112 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010113 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
10114 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010115 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
10116 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010117 break;
Devang Pateleaf42ab2008-09-23 23:03:40 +000010118 Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010119 if (PAttrs & Attribute::VarArgsIncompatible)
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010120 return false;
10121 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010122
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010123 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
10124 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
10125 std::vector<Value*> Args;
10126 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010127 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010128 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
10129
10130 // Get any return attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010131 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010132
10133 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
10134 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010135 RAttrs &= ~Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010136
10137 // Add the new return attributes.
10138 if (RAttrs)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010139 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010140
10141 AI = CS.arg_begin();
10142 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
10143 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
10144 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
10145 Args.push_back(*AI);
10146 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +000010147 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010148 false, ParamTy, false);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010149 Args.push_back(Builder->CreateCast(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp"));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010150 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010151
10152 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010153 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010154 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010155 }
10156
10157 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010158 // now.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010159 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000010160 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010161
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010162 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010163 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010164 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Daniel Dunbarce63ffb2009-07-25 00:23:56 +000010165 errs() << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
10166 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010167 } else {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010168 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010169 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
10170 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
10171 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
10172 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010173 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
10174 CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false, PTy, false);
10175 Args.push_back(Builder->CreateCast(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp"));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010176 } else {
10177 Args.push_back(*AI);
10178 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010179
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010180 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010181 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010182 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010183 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010184 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010185 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010186
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010187 if (Attributes FnAttrs = CallerPAL.getFnAttributes())
10188 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, FnAttrs));
10189
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010190 if (NewRetTy == Type::getVoidTy(*Context))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010191 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010192
Eric Christophera66297a2009-07-25 02:45:27 +000010193 const AttrListPtr &NewCallerPAL = AttrListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),
10194 attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010195
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010196 Instruction *NC;
10197 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010198 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010199 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
10200 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +000010201 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010202 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010203 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010204 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
10205 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +000010206 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
10207 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +000010208 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +000010209 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010210 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010211 }
10212
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010213 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010214 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010215 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010216 if (NV->getType() != Type::getVoidTy(*Context)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010217 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010218 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010219 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +000010220
10221 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
10222 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
10223 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000010224 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +000010225 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
10226 } else {
10227 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
10228 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
10229 }
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +000010230 Worklist.AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010231 } else {
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000010232 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010233 }
10234 }
10235
Chris Lattner931f8f32009-08-31 05:17:58 +000010236
10237 if (!Caller->use_empty())
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010238 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattner931f8f32009-08-31 05:17:58 +000010239
10240 EraseInstFromFunction(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010241 return true;
10242}
10243
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010244// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
10245// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
10246//
10247Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
10248 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
10249 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
10250 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010251 const AttrListPtr &Attrs = CS.getAttributes();
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010252
10253 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
10254 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010255 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(Attribute::Nest))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010256 return 0;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010257
10258 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
10259 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
10260
Anton Korobeynikov0b12ecf2008-05-07 22:54:15 +000010261 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010262 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
10263 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
10264
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010265 const AttrListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getAttributes();
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010266 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010267 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
10268 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010269 Attributes NestAttr = Attribute::None;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010270
10271 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
10272 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
10273 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010274 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, Attribute::Nest)) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010275 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
10276 NestTy = *I;
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010277 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttributes(NestIdx);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010278 break;
10279 }
10280
10281 if (NestTy) {
10282 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
10283 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
10284 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
10285
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010286 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010287 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010288
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010289 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010290 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
10291
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010292 // Add any result attributes.
10293 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getRetAttributes())
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010294 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010295
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010296 {
10297 unsigned Idx = 1;
10298 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
10299 do {
10300 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010301 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010302 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
10303 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
10304 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
10305 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010306 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010307 }
10308
10309 if (I == E)
10310 break;
10311
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010312 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010313 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010314 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttributes(Idx))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010315 NewAttrs.push_back
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010316 (AttributeWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010317
10318 ++Idx, ++I;
10319 } while (1);
10320 }
10321
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010322 // Add any function attributes.
10323 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getFnAttributes())
10324 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, Attr));
10325
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010326 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
10327 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010328 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010329
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010330 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010331 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
10332
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010333 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010334 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010335 {
10336 unsigned Idx = 1;
10337 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
10338 E = FTy->param_end();
10339
10340 do {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010341 if (Idx == NestIdx)
10342 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010343 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010344
10345 if (I == E)
10346 break;
10347
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010348 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010349 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010350
10351 ++Idx, ++I;
10352 } while (1);
10353 }
10354
10355 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
10356 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000010357 FunctionType *NewFTy = FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010358 FTy->isVarArg());
10359 Constant *NewCallee =
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000010360 NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +000010361 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF,
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000010362 PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
Eric Christophera66297a2009-07-25 02:45:27 +000010363 const AttrListPtr &NewPAL = AttrListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),
10364 NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010365
10366 Instruction *NewCaller;
10367 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010368 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
10369 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
10370 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
10371 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010372 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010373 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010374 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010375 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
10376 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010377 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
10378 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
10379 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
10380 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010381 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010382 }
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000010383 if (Caller->getType() != Type::getVoidTy(*Context) && !Caller->use_empty())
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010384 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
10385 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000010386 Worklist.Remove(Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010387 return 0;
10388 }
10389 }
10390
10391 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
10392 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
10393 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
10394 Constant *NewCallee =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010395 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF :
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +000010396 ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010397 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
10398 return CS.getInstruction();
10399}
10400
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000010401/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(a,c)]
10402/// and if a/b/c and the add's all have a single use, turn this into a phi
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010403/// and a single binop.
10404Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
10405 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +000010406 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010407 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010408 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
10409 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
10410
10411 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
10412 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010413
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000010414 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, and all have one use.
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010415 for (unsigned i = 1; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010416 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +000010417 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010418 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010419 // types or GEP's with different index types.
10420 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
10421 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010422 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010423
10424 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
10425 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
10426 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
10427 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
10428 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010429
10430 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
10431 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
10432 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010433 }
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000010434
10435 // If both LHS and RHS would need a PHI, don't do this transformation,
10436 // because it would increase the number of PHIs entering the block,
10437 // which leads to higher register pressure. This is especially
10438 // bad when the PHIs are in the header of a loop.
10439 if (!LHSVal && !RHSVal)
10440 return 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010441
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +000010442 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform!
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +000010443
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010444 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010445 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +000010446 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010447 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010448 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
10449 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010450 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
10451 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010452 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
10453 LHSVal = NewLHS;
10454 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010455
10456 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010457 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
10458 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010459 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
10460 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010461 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
10462 RHSVal = NewRHS;
10463 }
10464
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010465 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010466 if (NewLHS || NewRHS) {
10467 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10468 Instruction *InInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
10469 if (NewLHS) {
10470 Value *NewInLHS = InInst->getOperand(0);
10471 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10472 }
10473 if (NewRHS) {
10474 Value *NewInRHS = InInst->getOperand(1);
10475 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10476 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010477 }
10478 }
10479
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010480 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010481 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +000010482 CmpInst *CIOp = cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst);
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +000010483 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +000010484 LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010485}
10486
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010487Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
10488 GetElementPtrInst *FirstInst =cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
10489
10490 SmallVector<Value*, 16> FixedOperands(FirstInst->op_begin(),
10491 FirstInst->op_end());
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010492 // This is true if all GEP bases are allocas and if all indices into them are
10493 // constants.
10494 bool AllBasePointersAreAllocas = true;
Dan Gohmanb6c33852009-09-16 02:01:52 +000010495
10496 // We don't want to replace this phi if the replacement would require
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000010497 // more than one phi, which leads to higher register pressure. This is
10498 // especially bad when the PHIs are in the header of a loop.
Dan Gohmanb6c33852009-09-16 02:01:52 +000010499 bool NeededPhi = false;
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010500
Dan Gohman9ad29202009-09-16 16:50:24 +000010501 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, and all have one use.
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010502 for (unsigned i = 1; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
10503 GetElementPtrInst *GEP= dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
10504 if (!GEP || !GEP->hasOneUse() || GEP->getType() != FirstInst->getType() ||
10505 GEP->getNumOperands() != FirstInst->getNumOperands())
10506 return 0;
10507
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010508 // Keep track of whether or not all GEPs are of alloca pointers.
10509 if (AllBasePointersAreAllocas &&
10510 (!isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) ||
10511 !GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()))
10512 AllBasePointersAreAllocas = false;
10513
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010514 // Compare the operand lists.
10515 for (unsigned op = 0, e = FirstInst->getNumOperands(); op != e; ++op) {
10516 if (FirstInst->getOperand(op) == GEP->getOperand(op))
10517 continue;
10518
10519 // Don't merge two GEPs when two operands differ (introducing phi nodes)
10520 // if one of the PHIs has a constant for the index. The index may be
10521 // substantially cheaper to compute for the constants, so making it a
10522 // variable index could pessimize the path. This also handles the case
10523 // for struct indices, which must always be constant.
10524 if (isa<ConstantInt>(FirstInst->getOperand(op)) ||
10525 isa<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(op)))
10526 return 0;
10527
10528 if (FirstInst->getOperand(op)->getType() !=GEP->getOperand(op)->getType())
10529 return 0;
Dan Gohmanb6c33852009-09-16 02:01:52 +000010530
10531 // If we already needed a PHI for an earlier operand, and another operand
10532 // also requires a PHI, we'd be introducing more PHIs than we're
10533 // eliminating, which increases register pressure on entry to the PHI's
10534 // block.
10535 if (NeededPhi)
10536 return 0;
10537
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010538 FixedOperands[op] = 0; // Needs a PHI.
Dan Gohmanb6c33852009-09-16 02:01:52 +000010539 NeededPhi = true;
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010540 }
10541 }
10542
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010543 // If all of the base pointers of the PHI'd GEPs are from allocas, don't
Chris Lattner21550882009-02-23 05:56:17 +000010544 // bother doing this transformation. At best, this will just save a bit of
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010545 // offset calculation, but all the predecessors will have to materialize the
10546 // stack address into a register anyway. We'd actually rather *clone* the
10547 // load up into the predecessors so that we have a load of a gep of an alloca,
10548 // which can usually all be folded into the load.
10549 if (AllBasePointersAreAllocas)
10550 return 0;
10551
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010552 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform. Insert PHI nodes for each operand
10553 // that is variable.
10554 SmallVector<PHINode*, 16> OperandPhis(FixedOperands.size());
10555
10556 bool HasAnyPHIs = false;
10557 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FixedOperands.size(); i != e; ++i) {
10558 if (FixedOperands[i]) continue; // operand doesn't need a phi.
10559 Value *FirstOp = FirstInst->getOperand(i);
10560 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstOp->getType(),
10561 FirstOp->getName()+".pn");
10562 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
10563
10564 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(e);
10565 NewPN->addIncoming(FirstOp, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
10566 OperandPhis[i] = NewPN;
10567 FixedOperands[i] = NewPN;
10568 HasAnyPHIs = true;
10569 }
10570
10571
10572 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
10573 if (HasAnyPHIs) {
10574 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10575 GetElementPtrInst *InGEP =cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
10576 BasicBlock *InBB = PN.getIncomingBlock(i);
10577
10578 for (unsigned op = 0, e = OperandPhis.size(); op != e; ++op)
10579 if (PHINode *OpPhi = OperandPhis[op])
10580 OpPhi->addIncoming(InGEP->getOperand(op), InBB);
10581 }
10582 }
10583
10584 Value *Base = FixedOperands[0];
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000010585 return cast<GEPOperator>(FirstInst)->isInBounds() ?
10586 GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(Base, FixedOperands.begin()+1,
10587 FixedOperands.end()) :
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +000010588 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Base, FixedOperands.begin()+1,
10589 FixedOperands.end());
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010590}
10591
10592
Chris Lattner21550882009-02-23 05:56:17 +000010593/// isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe to
10594/// sink the load out of the block that defines it. This means that it must be
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010595/// obvious the value of the load is not changed from the point of the load to
10596/// the end of the block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000010597///
10598/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
10599/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
10600/// to a register.
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010601static bool isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010602 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
10603
10604 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
10605 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
10606 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000010607
10608 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
10609 // profitable to do this xform.
10610 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
10611 bool isAddressTaken = false;
10612 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
10613 UI != E; ++UI) {
10614 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
10615 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
10616 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
10617 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
10618 }
10619 isAddressTaken = true;
10620 break;
10621 }
10622
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010623 if (!isAddressTaken && AI->isStaticAlloca())
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000010624 return false;
10625 }
10626
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010627 // If this load is a load from a GEP with a constant offset from an alloca,
10628 // then we don't want to sink it. In its present form, it will be
10629 // load [constant stack offset]. Sinking it will cause us to have to
10630 // materialize the stack addresses in each predecessor in a register only to
10631 // do a shared load from register in the successor.
10632 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(L->getOperand(0)))
10633 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)))
10634 if (AI->isStaticAlloca() && GEP->hasAllConstantIndices())
10635 return false;
10636
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010637 return true;
10638}
10639
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010640
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010641// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
10642// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
10643// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
10644Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
10645 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
10646
10647 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
10648 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
10649 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
10650 // code size and simplifying code.
10651 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
10652 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010653 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010654 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
10655 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +000010656 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010657 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
10658 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010659 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010660 if (ConstantOp == 0)
10661 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010662 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
10663 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
10664 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
10665 // load and the PHI.
10666 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010667 !isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(LI))
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010668 return 0;
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +000010669
10670 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
10671 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
10672 // the path through the other successor.
10673 if (isVolatile &&
10674 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
10675 return 0;
10676
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010677 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010678 return FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010679 } else {
10680 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
10681 }
10682
10683 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
10684 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10685 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
10686 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010687 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010688 return 0;
10689 if (CastSrcTy) {
10690 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
10691 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010692 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010693 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
10694 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010695 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
10696 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010697 !isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(LI))
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010698 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010699
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +000010700 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
10701 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
10702 // the path through the other successor.
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010703 if (isVolatile &&
10704 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
10705 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010706
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010707 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
10708 return 0;
10709 }
10710 }
10711
10712 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
10713 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010714 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
10715 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +000010716 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010717
10718 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
10719 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010720
10721 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010722 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10723 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
10724 if (NewInVal != InVal)
10725 InVal = 0;
10726 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10727 }
10728
10729 Value *PhiVal;
10730 if (InVal) {
10731 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
10732 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
10733 PhiVal = InVal;
10734 delete NewPN;
10735 } else {
10736 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
10737 PhiVal = NewPN;
10738 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010739
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010740 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010741 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010742 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010743 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010744 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010745 if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Dan Gohman1c8a23c2009-08-25 23:17:54 +000010746 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010747 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010748 assert(isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst) && "Unknown operation");
10749
10750 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
10751 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
10752 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
10753 if (isVolatile)
10754 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
10755 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
10756
10757 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010758}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010759
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010760/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
10761/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010762static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
10763 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010764 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
10765 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
10766
10767 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010768 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010769 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +000010770
10771 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10772 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
10773 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010774
10775 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
10776 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010777
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010778 return false;
10779}
10780
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010781/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
10782/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
10783/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10784static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
10785 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
10786 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
10787 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
10788 return true;
10789
10790 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10791 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
10792 return false;
10793
10794 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
10795 // the value.
10796 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10797 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
10798 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
10799 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10800 return false;
10801 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
10802 return false;
10803 }
10804
10805 return true;
10806}
10807
10808
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010809// PHINode simplification
10810//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010811Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +000010812 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000010813 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +000010814
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010815 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
10816 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
10817
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010818 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
10819 // reducing code size.
10820 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010821 isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(1)) &&
10822 cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0))->getOpcode() ==
10823 cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(1))->getOpcode() &&
10824 // FIXME: The hasOneUse check will fail for PHIs that use the value more
10825 // than themselves more than once.
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010826 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
10827 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
10828 return Result;
10829
10830 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
10831 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
10832 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010833 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
10834 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
10835 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010836 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010837 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
10838 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000010839 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010840 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010841
10842 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
10843 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
10844 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
10845 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
10846 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
10847 // late.
10848 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
10849 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
10850 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000010851 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010852 }
10853 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010854
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010855 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
10856 // same value, for example:
10857 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10858 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
10859 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
10860 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
10861 {
10862 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
10863 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
10864 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
10865 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
10866 ++InValNo;
10867
10868 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
10869 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
10870
10871 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
10872 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
10873 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
10874 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
10875 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
10876 break;
10877 }
10878
10879 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
10880 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
10881 // the value.
10882 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
10883 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
10884 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10885 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
10886 }
10887 }
10888 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +000010889 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010890}
10891
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010892Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010893 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner963f4ba2009-08-30 20:36:46 +000010894 // Eliminate 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' and 'getelementptr %P', they are noops.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010895 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010896 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010897
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010898 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000010899 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010900
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010901 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
10902 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
10903 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
10904
10905 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010906 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010907
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010908 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000010909 if (TD) {
10910 bool MadeChange = false;
10911 unsigned PtrSize = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
10912
10913 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
10914 for (User::op_iterator I = GEP.op_begin() + 1, E = GEP.op_end();
10915 I != E; ++I, ++GTI) {
10916 if (!isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) continue;
10917
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010918 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000010919 // to what we need. If narrower, sign-extend it to what we need. This
10920 // explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more obvious.
10921 unsigned OpBits = cast<IntegerType>((*I)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000010922 if (OpBits == PtrSize)
10923 continue;
10924
Chris Lattner2345d1d2009-08-30 20:01:10 +000010925 *I = Builder->CreateIntCast(*I, TD->getIntPtrType(GEP.getContext()),true);
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000010926 MadeChange = true;
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010927 }
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000010928 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010929 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010930
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010931 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
10932 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
10933 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
10934 //
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +000010935 if (GEPOperator *Src = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010936 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
10937 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
10938 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
10939 //
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000010940 if (GetElementPtrInst *SrcGEP =
10941 dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src->getOperand(0)))
10942 if (SrcGEP->getNumOperands() == 2)
10943 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010944
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010945 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010946
10947 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
10948 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000010949 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*Src), E = gep_type_end(*Src);
10950 I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +000010951 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010952
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010953 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010954 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +000010955 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
10956 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
10957 //
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000010958 Value *Sum;
10959 Value *SO1 = Src->getOperand(Src->getNumOperands()-1);
10960 Value *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000010961 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010962 Sum = GO1;
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000010963 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010964 Sum = SO1;
10965 } else {
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000010966 // If they aren't the same type, then the input hasn't been processed
10967 // by the loop above yet (which canonicalizes sequential index types to
10968 // intptr_t). Just avoid transforming this until the input has been
10969 // normalized.
10970 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType())
10971 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000010972 Sum = Builder->CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010973 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010974
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000010975 // Update the GEP in place if possible.
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000010976 if (Src->getNumOperands() == 2) {
10977 GEP.setOperand(0, Src->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010978 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
10979 return &GEP;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010980 }
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000010981 Indices.append(Src->op_begin()+1, Src->op_end()-1);
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000010982 Indices.push_back(Sum);
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000010983 Indices.append(GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010984 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010985 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000010986 Src->getNumOperands() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010987 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000010988 Indices.append(Src->op_begin()+1, Src->op_end());
10989 Indices.append(GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010990 }
10991
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000010992 if (!Indices.empty())
10993 return (cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() &&
10994 Src->isInBounds()) ?
10995 GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(Src->getOperand(0), Indices.begin(),
10996 Indices.end(), GEP.getName()) :
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000010997 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src->getOperand(0), Indices.begin(),
Chris Lattnerccf4b342009-08-30 04:49:01 +000010998 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner6e24d832009-08-30 05:00:50 +000010999 }
11000
Chris Lattnerf9b91bb2009-08-30 05:08:50 +000011001 // Handle gep(bitcast x) and gep(gep x, 0, 0, 0).
11002 if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner6e24d832009-08-30 05:00:50 +000011003 assert(isa<PointerType>(X->getType()) && "Must be cast from pointer");
Chris Lattner963f4ba2009-08-30 20:36:46 +000011004
Chris Lattner2de23192009-08-30 20:38:21 +000011005 // If the input bitcast is actually "bitcast(bitcast(x))", then we don't
11006 // want to change the gep until the bitcasts are eliminated.
11007 if (getBitCastOperand(X)) {
11008 Worklist.AddValue(PtrOp);
11009 return 0;
11010 }
11011
Chris Lattner963f4ba2009-08-30 20:36:46 +000011012 // Transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
11013 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
11014 //
11015 // Likewise, transform: GEP (bitcast i8* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
11016 // into : GEP i8* X, ...
11017 //
11018 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
Chris Lattner6e24d832009-08-30 05:00:50 +000011019 if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011020 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
11021 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011022 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
11023 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType())) {
11024 // GEP (bitcast i8* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ... ?
11025 if (CATy->getElementType() == XTy->getElementType()) {
11026 // -> GEP i8* X, ...
11027 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices(GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011028 return cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
11029 GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(X, Indices.begin(), Indices.end(),
11030 GEP.getName()) :
Dan Gohmand6aa02d2009-07-28 01:40:03 +000011031 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Indices.begin(), Indices.end(),
11032 GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner963f4ba2009-08-30 20:36:46 +000011033 }
11034
11035 if (const ArrayType *XATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType())){
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011036 // GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ... ?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011037 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011038 // -> GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011039 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
11040 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
11041 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
11042 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
11043 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
11044 return &GEP;
11045 }
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011046 }
11047 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011048 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
11049 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011050 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
11051 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011052 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
11053 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011054 if (TD && isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +000011055 TD->getTypeAllocSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
11056 TD->getTypeAllocSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011057 Value *Idx[2];
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000011058 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011059 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011060 Value *NewGEP = cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
11061 Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()) :
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011062 Builder->CreateGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011063 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011064 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000011065 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011066
11067 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011068 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011069 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011070 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011071
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000011072 if (TD && isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::getInt8Ty(*Context)) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011073 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +000011074 TD->getTypeAllocSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011075
11076 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
11077 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
11078 Value *NewIdx = 0;
11079 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
11080 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
11081 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerab984842009-08-30 05:30:55 +000011082 Scale = ConstantInt::get(cast<IntegerType>(NewIdx->getType()), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011083 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +000011084 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011085 Scale = CI;
11086 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
11087 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
11088 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +000011089 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
11090 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +000011091 Scale = ConstantInt::get(cast<IntegerType>(Inst->getType()),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +000011092 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011093 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
11094 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
11095 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
11096 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
11097 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
11098 }
11099 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011100
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011101 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011102 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
11103 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
11104 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
Chris Lattner58b1ac72009-02-25 18:20:01 +000011105 if (ArrayEltSize && Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011106 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +000011107 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011108 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011109 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Chris Lattner878daed2009-08-30 05:56:44 +000011110 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
11111 false /*ZExt*/);
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011112 NewIdx = Builder->CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011113 }
11114
11115 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011116 Value *Idx[2];
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000011117 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011118 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011119 Value *NewGEP = cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
11120 Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()) :
11121 Builder->CreateGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011122 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
11123 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011124 }
11125 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000011126 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011127 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011128
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011129 /// See if we can simplify:
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000011130 /// X = bitcast A* to B*
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011131 /// Y = gep X, <...constant indices...>
11132 /// into a gep of the original struct. This is important for SROA and alias
11133 /// analysis of unions. If "A" is also a bitcast, wait for A/X to be merged.
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011134 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(PtrOp)) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011135 if (TD &&
11136 !isa<BitCastInst>(BCI->getOperand(0)) && GEP.hasAllConstantIndices()) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011137 // Determine how much the GEP moves the pointer. We are guaranteed to get
11138 // a constant back from EmitGEPOffset.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011139 ConstantInt *OffsetV =
11140 cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(&GEP, GEP, *this));
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011141 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
11142
11143 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, just replace the GEP
11144 // with a bitcast of the real input to the dest type.
11145 if (Offset == 0) {
11146 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
11147 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +000011148 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0)) ||
11149 isMalloc(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011150 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
11151 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
11152 if (I != BCI) {
11153 I->takeName(BCI);
11154 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
11155 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
11156 }
11157 return &GEP;
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011158 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011159 }
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011160 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011161 }
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011162
11163 // Otherwise, if the offset is non-zero, we need to find out if there is a
11164 // field at Offset in 'A's type. If so, we can pull the cast through the
11165 // GEP.
11166 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
11167 const Type *InTy =
11168 cast<PointerType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011169 if (FindElementAtOffset(InTy, Offset, NewIndices, TD, Context)) {
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011170 Value *NGEP = cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
11171 Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(BCI->getOperand(0), NewIndices.begin(),
11172 NewIndices.end()) :
11173 Builder->CreateGEP(BCI->getOperand(0), NewIndices.begin(),
11174 NewIndices.end());
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011175
11176 if (NGEP->getType() == GEP.getType())
11177 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, NGEP);
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011178 NGEP->takeName(&GEP);
11179 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, GEP.getType());
11180 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011181 }
11182 }
11183
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011184 return 0;
11185}
11186
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011187Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
11188 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011189 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011190 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
11191 const Type *NewTy =
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000011192 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000011193 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011194
11195 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
11196 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011197 New = Builder->CreateMalloc(NewTy, 0, AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000011198 else {
11199 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011200 New = Builder->CreateAlloca(NewTy, 0, AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000011201 }
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011202 New->setAlignment(AI.getAlignment());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011203
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011204 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
Dale Johannesena8915182009-03-11 22:19:43 +000011205 // allocas if possible...also skip interleaved debug info
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011206 //
11207 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
Dale Johannesena8915182009-03-11 22:19:43 +000011208 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It) || isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(*It)) ++It;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011209
11210 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
11211 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
11212 //
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000011213 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011214 Value *Idx[2];
11215 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
11216 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011217 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
11218 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011219
11220 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
11221 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000011222 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011223 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000011224 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011225 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011226 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000011227
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011228 if (TD && isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized()) {
Dan Gohman6893cd72009-01-13 20:18:38 +000011229 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
Chris Lattner46d232d2009-03-17 17:55:15 +000011230 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate
11231 // and return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +000011232 if (TD->getTypeAllocSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000011233 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Dan Gohman6893cd72009-01-13 20:18:38 +000011234
11235 // If the alignment is 0 (unspecified), assign it the preferred alignment.
11236 if (AI.getAlignment() == 0)
11237 AI.setAlignment(TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(AI.getAllocatedType()));
11238 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000011239
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011240 return 0;
11241}
11242
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000011243Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
11244 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
11245
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011246 // free undef -> unreachable.
11247 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
11248 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Owen Anderson5defacc2009-07-31 17:39:07 +000011249 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(*Context),
Duncan Sandsac53a0b2009-10-06 15:40:36 +000011250 UndefValue::get(Type::getInt1PtrTy(*Context)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011251 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
11252 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000011253
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000011254 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
11255 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011256 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011257 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000011258
11259 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
11260 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
11261 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
11262 return &FI;
11263 }
11264
11265 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
11266 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
11267 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011268 Worklist.Add(GEPI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000011269 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
11270 return &FI;
11271 }
11272 }
11273
11274 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
11275 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
11276 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
11277 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
11278 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
11279 }
Victor Hernandez83d63912009-09-18 22:35:49 +000011280 if (isMalloc(Op)) {
11281 if (CallInst* CI = extractMallocCallFromBitCast(Op)) {
11282 if (Op->hasOneUse() && CI->hasOneUse()) {
11283 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
11284 EraseInstFromFunction(*CI);
11285 return EraseInstFromFunction(*cast<Instruction>(Op));
11286 }
11287 } else {
11288 // Op is a call to malloc
11289 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
11290 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
11291 return EraseInstFromFunction(*cast<Instruction>(Op));
11292 }
11293 }
11294 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000011295
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000011296 return 0;
11297}
11298
11299
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011300/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000011301static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000011302 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011303 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011304 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000011305 LLVMContext *Context = IC.getContext();
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011306
Nick Lewycky48f95ad2009-05-08 06:47:37 +000011307 if (TD) {
11308 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
11309 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
11310 // directly if string length is small enough.
11311 std::string Str;
11312 if (GetConstantStringInfo(CE->getOperand(0), Str) && !Str.empty()) {
11313 unsigned len = Str.length();
11314 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
11315 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
11316 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
11317 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
11318 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
11319 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
11320 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
11321 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
11322 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i] & UCHAR_MAX;
11323 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
11324 }
11325 } else {
11326 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
11327 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i] & UCHAR_MAX;
11328 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
11329 }
11330 // Append NULL at the end.
11331 SingleChar = 0;
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000011332 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
11333 }
Owen Andersoneed707b2009-07-24 23:12:02 +000011334 Value *NL = ConstantInt::get(*Context, StrVal);
Nick Lewycky48f95ad2009-05-08 06:47:37 +000011335 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000011336 }
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000011337 }
11338 }
11339 }
11340
Mon P Wang6753f952009-02-07 22:19:29 +000011341 const PointerType *DestTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType());
11342 const Type *DestPTy = DestTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011343 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Mon P Wang6753f952009-02-07 22:19:29 +000011344
11345 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the cast.
11346 if (DestTy->getAddressSpace() != SrcTy->getAddressSpace())
11347 return 0;
11348
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011349 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011350
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000011351 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011352 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011353 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
11354 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
11355 // constants.
11356 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
11357 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
11358 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000011359 Value *Idxs[2];
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000011360 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +000011361 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011362 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
11363 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
11364 }
11365
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011366 if (IC.getTargetData() &&
11367 (SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011368 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +000011369 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
11370 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
11371 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011372 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
11373 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011374
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011375 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
11376 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
11377 // the result of the loaded value.
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011378 Value *NewLoad =
11379 IC.Builder->CreateLoad(CastOp, LI.isVolatile(), CI->getName());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011380 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000011381 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011382 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011383 }
11384 }
11385 return 0;
11386}
11387
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000011388Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
11389 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +000011390
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011391 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011392 if (TD) {
11393 unsigned KnownAlign =
11394 GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op, TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(LI.getType()));
11395 if (KnownAlign >
11396 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
11397 LI.getAlignment()))
11398 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
11399 }
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011400
Chris Lattner963f4ba2009-08-30 20:36:46 +000011401 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011402 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000011403 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011404 return Res;
11405
11406 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
11407 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000011408
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011409 // Do really simple store-to-load forwarding and load CSE, to catch cases
11410 // where there are several consequtive memory accesses to the same location,
11411 // separated by a few arithmetic operations.
11412 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI;
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011413 if (Value *AvailableVal = FindAvailableLoadedValue(Op, LI.getParent(), BBI,6))
11414 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, AvailableVal);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011415
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000011416 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
11417 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
11418 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
Chris Lattner8a67ac52009-08-30 20:06:40 +000011419 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) && GEPI->getPointerAddressSpace() == 0){
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011420 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
11421 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
11422 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
11423 // CFG.
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011424 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000011425 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011426 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011427 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000011428 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011429
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011430 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011431 // load null/undef -> undef
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000011432 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
Chris Lattner8a67ac52009-08-30 20:06:40 +000011433 if (isa<UndefValue>(C) ||
11434 (C->isNullValue() && LI.getPointerAddressSpace() == 0)) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011435 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
11436 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
11437 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011438 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000011439 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011440 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011441 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000011442
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011443 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
11444 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Duncan Sands64da9402009-03-21 21:27:31 +000011445 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasDefinitiveInitializer())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011446 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011447
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011448 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011449 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011450 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
11451 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Duncan Sands64da9402009-03-21 21:27:31 +000011452 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasDefinitiveInitializer())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +000011453 if (Constant *V =
Dan Gohmanc6f69e92009-10-05 16:36:26 +000011454 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011455 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011456 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
11457 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
11458 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
11459 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
11460 // CFG.
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011461 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000011462 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011463 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011464 }
11465
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011466 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000011467 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011468 return Res;
11469 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011470 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011471 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000011472
11473 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
11474 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
Duncan Sands5d0392c2008-10-01 15:25:41 +000011475 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op->getUnderlyingObject())){
Duncan Sands64da9402009-03-21 21:27:31 +000011476 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasDefinitiveInitializer()) {
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000011477 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000011478 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000011479 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011480 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000011481 }
11482 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +000011483
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011484 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011485 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
11486 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
11487 // exposes redundancy in the code.
11488 //
11489 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
11490 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
11491 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
11492 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
11493 // unconditionally.
11494 //
11495 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
11496 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000011497 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
11498 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011499 Value *V1 = Builder->CreateLoad(SI->getOperand(1),
11500 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val");
11501 Value *V2 = Builder->CreateLoad(SI->getOperand(2),
11502 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val");
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011503 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011504 }
11505
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +000011506 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
11507 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
11508 if (C->isNullValue()) {
11509 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
11510 return &LI;
11511 }
11512
11513 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
11514 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
11515 if (C->isNullValue()) {
11516 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
11517 return &LI;
11518 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011519 }
11520 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000011521 return 0;
11522}
11523
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +000011524/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011525/// when possible. This makes it generally easy to do alias analysis and/or
11526/// SROA/mem2reg of the memory object.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011527static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
11528 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
11529 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
11530
11531 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011532 const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
11533 if (SrcTy == 0) return 0;
11534
11535 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011536
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011537 if (!DestPTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(DestPTy))
11538 return 0;
11539
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011540 /// NewGEPIndices - If SrcPTy is an aggregate type, we can emit a "noop gep"
11541 /// to its first element. This allows us to handle things like:
11542 /// store i32 xxx, (bitcast {foo*, float}* %P to i32*)
11543 /// on 32-bit hosts.
11544 SmallVector<Value*, 4> NewGEPIndices;
11545
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011546 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
11547 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
11548 // constants.
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011549 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcPTy) || isa<StructType>(SrcPTy)) {
11550 // Index through pointer.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000011551 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(*IC.getContext()));
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011552 NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
11553
11554 while (1) {
11555 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcPTy)) {
Torok Edwin08ffee52009-01-24 17:16:04 +000011556 if (!STy->getNumElements()) /* Struct can be empty {} */
Torok Edwin629e92b2009-01-24 11:30:49 +000011557 break;
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011558 NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
11559 SrcPTy = STy->getElementType(0);
11560 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy)) {
11561 NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
11562 SrcPTy = ATy->getElementType();
11563 } else {
11564 break;
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011565 }
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011566 }
11567
Owen Andersondebcb012009-07-29 22:17:13 +000011568 SrcTy = PointerType::get(SrcPTy, SrcTy->getAddressSpace());
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011569 }
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011570
11571 if (!SrcPTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy))
11572 return 0;
11573
Chris Lattner71759c42009-01-16 20:12:52 +000011574 // If the pointers point into different address spaces or if they point to
11575 // values with different sizes, we can't do the transformation.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011576 if (!IC.getTargetData() ||
11577 SrcTy->getAddressSpace() !=
Chris Lattner71759c42009-01-16 20:12:52 +000011578 cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getAddressSpace() ||
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011579 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) !=
11580 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy))
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011581 return 0;
11582
11583 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
11584 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
11585 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
11586 Value *NewCast;
11587 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
11588 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
11589 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
11590 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
11591 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
11592 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
11593 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
11594 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
11595 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
11596 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011597 }
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011598
11599 // SIOp0 is a pointer to aggregate and this is a store to the first field,
11600 // emit a GEP to index into its first field.
Dan Gohmanf8dbee72009-09-07 23:54:19 +000011601 if (!NewGEPIndices.empty())
11602 CastOp = IC.Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(CastOp, NewGEPIndices.begin(),
11603 NewGEPIndices.end());
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011604
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000011605 NewCast = IC.Builder->CreateCast(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy,
11606 SIOp0->getName()+".c");
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011607 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011608}
11609
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011610/// equivalentAddressValues - Test if A and B will obviously have the same
11611/// value. This includes recognizing that %t0 and %t1 will have the same
11612/// value in code like this:
Dan Gohman0f8b53f2009-03-03 02:55:14 +000011613/// %t0 = getelementptr \@a, 0, 3
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011614/// store i32 0, i32* %t0
Dan Gohman0f8b53f2009-03-03 02:55:14 +000011615/// %t1 = getelementptr \@a, 0, 3
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011616/// %t2 = load i32* %t1
11617///
11618static bool equivalentAddressValues(Value *A, Value *B) {
11619 // Test if the values are trivially equivalent.
11620 if (A == B) return true;
11621
11622 // Test if the values come form identical arithmetic instructions.
Dan Gohman58cfa3b2009-08-25 22:11:20 +000011623 // This uses isIdenticalToWhenDefined instead of isIdenticalTo because
11624 // its only used to compare two uses within the same basic block, which
11625 // means that they'll always either have the same value or one of them
11626 // will have an undefined value.
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011627 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(A) ||
11628 isa<CastInst>(A) ||
11629 isa<PHINode>(A) ||
11630 isa<GetElementPtrInst>(A))
11631 if (Instruction *BI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(B))
Dan Gohman58cfa3b2009-08-25 22:11:20 +000011632 if (cast<Instruction>(A)->isIdenticalToWhenDefined(BI))
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011633 return true;
11634
11635 // Otherwise they may not be equivalent.
11636 return false;
11637}
11638
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +000011639// If this instruction has two uses, one of which is a llvm.dbg.declare,
11640// return the llvm.dbg.declare.
11641DbgDeclareInst *InstCombiner::hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Value *V) {
11642 if (!V->hasNUses(2))
11643 return 0;
11644 for (Value::use_iterator UI = V->use_begin(), E = V->use_end();
11645 UI != E; ++UI) {
11646 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = dyn_cast<DbgDeclareInst>(UI))
11647 return DI;
11648 if (isa<BitCastInst>(UI) && UI->hasOneUse()) {
11649 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = dyn_cast<DbgDeclareInst>(UI->use_begin()))
11650 return DI;
11651 }
11652 }
11653 return 0;
11654}
11655
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011656Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
11657 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
11658 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
11659
11660 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011661 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011662 ++NumCombined;
11663 return 0;
11664 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000011665
11666 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
11667 // alloca dead.
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +000011668 // If the RHS is an alloca with a two uses, the other one being a
11669 // llvm.dbg.declare, zapify the store and the declare, making the
11670 // alloca dead. We must do this to prevent declare's from affecting
11671 // codegen.
11672 if (!SI.isVolatile()) {
11673 if (Ptr->hasOneUse()) {
11674 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000011675 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11676 ++NumCombined;
11677 return 0;
11678 }
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +000011679 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr)) {
11680 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
11681 if (GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
11682 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11683 ++NumCombined;
11684 return 0;
11685 }
11686 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
11687 EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
11688 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11689 ++NumCombined;
11690 return 0;
11691 }
11692 }
11693 }
11694 }
11695 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Ptr)) {
11696 EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
11697 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11698 ++NumCombined;
11699 return 0;
11700 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000011701 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011702
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011703 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011704 if (TD) {
11705 unsigned KnownAlign =
11706 GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr, TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(Val->getType()));
11707 if (KnownAlign >
11708 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
11709 SI.getAlignment()))
11710 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
11711 }
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011712
Dale Johannesenacb51a32009-03-03 01:43:03 +000011713 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consecutive
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011714 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
11715 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
11716 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
11717 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
11718 --ScanInsts) {
Dale Johannesen0d6596b2009-03-04 01:20:34 +000011719 --BBI;
Dale Johannesencdb16aa2009-03-04 01:53:05 +000011720 // Don't count debug info directives, lest they affect codegen,
11721 // and we skip pointer-to-pointer bitcasts, which are NOPs.
11722 // It is necessary for correctness to skip those that feed into a
11723 // llvm.dbg.declare, as these are not present when debugging is off.
Dale Johannesen4ded40a2009-03-03 22:36:47 +000011724 if (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
Dale Johannesencdb16aa2009-03-04 01:53:05 +000011725 (isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType()))) {
Dale Johannesenacb51a32009-03-03 01:43:03 +000011726 ScanInsts++;
Dale Johannesenacb51a32009-03-03 01:43:03 +000011727 continue;
11728 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011729
11730 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
11731 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011732 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() &&equivalentAddressValues(PrevSI->getOperand(1),
11733 SI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011734 ++NumDeadStore;
11735 ++BBI;
11736 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
11737 continue;
11738 }
11739 break;
11740 }
11741
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011742 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
11743 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
11744 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
11745 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011746 if (LI == Val && equivalentAddressValues(LI->getOperand(0), Ptr) &&
11747 !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011748 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11749 ++NumCombined;
11750 return 0;
11751 }
11752 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
11753 // may not be dead.
11754 break;
11755 }
11756
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011757 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner0ef546e2008-05-08 17:20:30 +000011758 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011759 break;
11760 }
11761
11762
11763 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011764
11765 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
Chris Lattner8a67ac52009-08-30 20:06:40 +000011766 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr) && SI.getPointerAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011767 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000011768 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011769 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011770 Worklist.Add(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011771 ++NumCombined;
11772 }
11773 return 0; // Do not modify these!
11774 }
11775
11776 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
11777 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011778 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011779 ++NumCombined;
11780 return 0;
11781 }
11782
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011783 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
11784 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011785 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011786 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11787 return Res;
11788 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011789 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011790 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11791 return Res;
11792
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011793
Dale Johannesen4084c4e2009-03-05 02:06:48 +000011794 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block (possibly
11795 // excepting debug info instructions and the pointer bitcasts that feed
11796 // into them), and if the block ends with an unconditional branch, try
11797 // to move it to the successor block.
11798 BBI = &SI;
11799 do {
11800 ++BBI;
11801 } while (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
11802 (isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType())));
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011803 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011804 if (BI->isUnconditional())
11805 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
11806 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011807
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011808 return 0;
11809}
11810
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011811/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
11812/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
11813/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11814///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011815/// Simplify things like:
11816/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
11817/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11818///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011819bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
11820 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
11821
11822 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
11823 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
11824 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011825 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011826
11827 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
11828 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011829 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
11830 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011831 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011832 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011833 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011834 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011835 return false;
11836
11837 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011838 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011839 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011840 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011841 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011842 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011843 return false;
Eli Friedman66fe80a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000011844
11845 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
11846 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
11847 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
11848 return false;
11849
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011850 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
11851 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011852 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011853 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011854 return false;
11855
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011856 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
11857 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
11858 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
11859 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011860 --BBI;
Dale Johannesen4084c4e2009-03-05 02:06:48 +000011861 // Skip over debugging info.
11862 while (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
11863 (isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType()))) {
11864 if (BBI==OtherBB->begin())
11865 return false;
11866 --BBI;
11867 }
11868 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011869 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
11870 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11871 return false;
11872 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000011873 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011874 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
11875 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
11876 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
11877 return false;
11878
11879 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000011880 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
11881 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011882 for (;; --BBI) {
11883 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
11884 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
11885 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11886 return false;
11887 break;
11888 }
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011889 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
11890 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
11891 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011892 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
11893 return false;
11894 }
11895
11896 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011897 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
11898 // StoreBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011899 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
11900 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011901 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011902 return false;
11903 }
11904 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011905
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011906 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011907 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
11908 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011909 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011910 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
11911 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011912 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
11913 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011914 }
11915
11916 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
11917 // insert it.
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011918 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011919 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
11920 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
11921
11922 // Nuke the old stores.
11923 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11924 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
11925 ++NumCombined;
11926 return true;
11927}
11928
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011929
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011930Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
11931 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +000011932 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011933 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
11934 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
Dan Gohman4ae51262009-08-12 16:23:25 +000011935 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011936 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
11937 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11938 BI.setCondition(X);
11939 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11940 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
11941 return &BI;
11942 }
11943
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011944 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
11945 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
11946 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011947 TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
11948 BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse())
11949 if (FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
11950 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) {
11951 FCmpInst *Cond = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
11952 Cond->setPredicate(FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred));
11953
11954 // Swap Destinations and condition.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011955 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11956 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011957 Worklist.Add(Cond);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011958 return &BI;
11959 }
11960
11961 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
11962 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
11963 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011964 TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
11965 BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse())
11966 if (IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
11967 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
11968 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) {
11969 ICmpInst *Cond = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
11970 Cond->setPredicate(ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred));
11971 // Swap Destinations and condition.
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011972 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11973 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011974 Worklist.Add(Cond);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011975 return &BI;
11976 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011977
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011978 return 0;
11979}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011980
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011981Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
11982 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
11983 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
11984 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
11985 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
11986 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
11987 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011988 SI.setOperand(i,
Owen Andersonbaf3c402009-07-29 18:55:55 +000011989 ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011990 AddRHS));
11991 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000011992 Worklist.Add(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011993 return &SI;
11994 }
11995 }
11996 return 0;
11997}
11998
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011999Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012000 Value *Agg = EV.getAggregateOperand();
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000012001
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012002 if (!EV.hasIndices())
12003 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Agg);
12004
12005 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Agg)) {
12006 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012007 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, UndefValue::get(EV.getType()));
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012008
12009 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000012010 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Constant::getNullValue(EV.getType()));
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012011
12012 if (isa<ConstantArray>(C) || isa<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
12013 // Extract the element indexed by the first index out of the constant
12014 Value *V = C->getOperand(*EV.idx_begin());
12015 if (EV.getNumIndices() > 1)
12016 // Extract the remaining indices out of the constant indexed by the
12017 // first index
12018 return ExtractValueInst::Create(V, EV.idx_begin() + 1, EV.idx_end());
12019 else
12020 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, V);
12021 }
12022 return 0; // Can't handle other constants
12023 }
12024 if (InsertValueInst *IV = dyn_cast<InsertValueInst>(Agg)) {
12025 // We're extracting from an insertvalue instruction, compare the indices
12026 const unsigned *exti, *exte, *insi, *inse;
12027 for (exti = EV.idx_begin(), insi = IV->idx_begin(),
12028 exte = EV.idx_end(), inse = IV->idx_end();
12029 exti != exte && insi != inse;
12030 ++exti, ++insi) {
12031 if (*insi != *exti)
12032 // The insert and extract both reference distinctly different elements.
12033 // This means the extract is not influenced by the insert, and we can
12034 // replace the aggregate operand of the extract with the aggregate
12035 // operand of the insert. i.e., replace
12036 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
12037 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 0
12038 // with
12039 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 0
12040 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
12041 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
12042 }
12043 if (exti == exte && insi == inse)
12044 // Both iterators are at the end: Index lists are identical. Replace
12045 // %B = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
12046 // %C = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %B, 1, 0
12047 // with "i32 42"
12048 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand());
12049 if (exti == exte) {
12050 // The extract list is a prefix of the insert list. i.e. replace
12051 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
12052 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1
12053 // with
12054 // %X = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 1
12055 // %E = insertvalue { i32 } %X, i32 42, 0
12056 // by switching the order of the insert and extract (though the
12057 // insertvalue should be left in, since it may have other uses).
Chris Lattnerf925cbd2009-08-30 18:50:58 +000012058 Value *NewEV = Builder->CreateExtractValue(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
12059 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012060 return InsertValueInst::Create(NewEV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
12061 insi, inse);
12062 }
12063 if (insi == inse)
12064 // The insert list is a prefix of the extract list
12065 // We can simply remove the common indices from the extract and make it
12066 // operate on the inserted value instead of the insertvalue result.
12067 // i.e., replace
12068 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
12069 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1, 0
12070 // with
12071 // %E extractvalue { i32 } { i32 42 }, 0
12072 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
12073 exti, exte);
12074 }
12075 // Can't simplify extracts from other values. Note that nested extracts are
12076 // already simplified implicitely by the above (extract ( extract (insert) )
12077 // will be translated into extract ( insert ( extract ) ) first and then just
12078 // the value inserted, if appropriate).
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000012079 return 0;
12080}
12081
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012082/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
12083/// is to leave as a vector operation.
12084static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
12085 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
12086 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012087 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012088 if (isConstant) return true;
12089 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
12090 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
12091 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
12092 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
12093 return false;
12094 return true;
12095 }
12096 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
12097 if (!I) return false;
12098
12099 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
12100 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
12101 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
12102 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
12103 return true;
12104 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
12105 return true;
12106 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
12107 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
12108 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
12109 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
12110 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012111 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
12112 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
12113 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
12114 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
12115 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012116
12117 return false;
12118}
12119
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +000012120/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
12121///
12122/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
12123/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012124static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
12125 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
12126 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
12127 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
12128 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
12129 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
12130
12131 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012132 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000012133 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
12134 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012135 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
12136 else
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000012137 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012138 return Result;
12139}
12140
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012141/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
12142/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
12143/// extracted from the vector.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012144static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000012145 LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012146 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
12147 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000012148 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
12149 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012150 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012151
12152 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012153 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012154 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000012155 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012156 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012157 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
12158 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
12159 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012160 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
12161 return 0;
12162 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012163
12164 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
12165 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012166 if (EltNo == IIElt)
12167 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012168
12169 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
12170 // vector input.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012171 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo, Context);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000012172 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012173 unsigned LHSWidth =
12174 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012175 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012176 if (InEl < LHSWidth)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012177 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl, Context);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012178 else if (InEl < LHSWidth*2)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012179 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - LHSWidth, Context);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012180 else
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012181 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012182 }
12183
12184 // Otherwise, we don't know.
12185 return 0;
12186}
12187
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012188Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000012189 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012190 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012191 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012192
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000012193 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012194 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
Owen Andersona7235ea2009-07-31 20:28:14 +000012195 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012196
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012197 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmanb4d6a5a2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000012198 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
12199 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
12200 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012201 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner4cb81bd2009-09-08 03:44:51 +000012202 for (unsigned i = 1; i != C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012203 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
12204 op0 = 0;
12205 break;
12206 }
12207 if (op0)
12208 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012209 }
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000012210
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012211 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
12212 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012213 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000012214 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner4cb81bd2009-09-08 03:44:51 +000012215 unsigned VectorWidth = EI.getVectorOperandType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000012216
12217 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
12218 // crashing the code below.
12219 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012220 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000012221
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012222 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
12223 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
12224 // property.
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000012225 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +000012226 APInt UndefElts(VectorWidth, 0);
12227 APInt DemandedMask(VectorWidth, 1 << IndexVal);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012228 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +000012229 DemandedMask, UndefElts)) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012230 EI.setOperand(0, V);
12231 return &EI;
12232 }
12233 }
12234
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012235 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal, Context))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012236 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000012237
12238 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
12239 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
12240 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
12241 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
12242 if (const VectorType *VT =
12243 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
12244 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012245 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0),
12246 IndexVal, Context))
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000012247 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
12248 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000012249 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012250
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012251 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner275a6d62009-09-08 18:48:01 +000012252 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
12253 // profitable to do so
12254 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
12255 if (I->hasOneUse() &&
12256 CheapToScalarize(BO, isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1)))) {
12257 Value *newEI0 =
12258 Builder->CreateExtractElement(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
12259 EI.getName()+".lhs");
12260 Value *newEI1 =
12261 Builder->CreateExtractElement(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
12262 EI.getName()+".rhs");
12263 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012264 }
Chris Lattner275a6d62009-09-08 18:48:01 +000012265 } else if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012266 // Extracting the inserted element?
12267 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
12268 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
12269 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
12270 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +000012271 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) && isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner3c4e38e2009-08-30 06:27:41 +000012272 Worklist.AddValue(EI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012273 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
12274 return &EI;
12275 }
12276 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
12277 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
12278 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012279 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
12280 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012281 Value *Src;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012282 unsigned LHSWidth =
12283 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
12284
12285 if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth)
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012286 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012287 else if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth*2) {
12288 SrcIdx -= LHSWidth;
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012289 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
12290 } else {
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012291 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000012292 }
Eric Christophera3500da2009-07-25 02:28:41 +000012293 return ExtractElementInst::Create(Src,
Chris Lattner08142f22009-08-30 19:47:22 +000012294 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), SrcIdx,
12295 false));
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012296 }
12297 }
Eli Friedman2451a642009-07-18 23:06:53 +000012298 // FIXME: Canonicalize extractelement(bitcast) -> bitcast(extractelement)
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012299 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012300 return 0;
12301}
12302
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012303/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
12304/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
12305/// Otherwise, return false.
12306static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012307 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000012308 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012309 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
12310 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012311 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012312
12313 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012314 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012315 return true;
12316 } else if (V == LHS) {
12317 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012318 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012319 return true;
12320 } else if (V == RHS) {
12321 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012322 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012323 return true;
12324 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
12325 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
12326 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
12327 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
12328 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
12329
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012330 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
12331 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012332 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012333
12334 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
12335 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
12336 // transitively ok.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012337 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask, Context)) {
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012338 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012339 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context));
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012340 return true;
12341 }
12342 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
12343 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012344 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
12345 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012346 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012347
12348 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
12349 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
12350 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
12351 // transitively ok.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012352 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask, Context)) {
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012353 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
12354 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012355 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012356 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012357 } else {
12358 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012359 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012360 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012361
12362 }
12363 return true;
12364 }
12365 }
12366 }
12367 }
12368 }
12369 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
12370
12371 return false;
12372}
12373
12374/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
12375/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
12376/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012377static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000012378 Value *&RHS, LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012379 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012380 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012381 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012382 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012383
12384 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012385 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012386 return V;
12387 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012388 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012389 return V;
12390 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
12391 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
12392 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
12393 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
12394 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
12395
12396 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
12397 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
12398 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
12399 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012400 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
12401 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012402
12403 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
12404 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012405 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
12406 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012407 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS, Context);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012408 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012409 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012410 return V;
12411 }
12412
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012413 if (VecOp == RHS) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012414 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask,
12415 RHS, Context);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012416 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
12417 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
12418 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012419 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012420 }
12421 return V;
12422 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012423
12424 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
12425 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012426 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask,
12427 Context))
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012428 return EI->getOperand(0);
12429
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012430 }
12431 }
12432 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012433 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012434
12435 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
12436 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012437 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012438 return V;
12439}
12440
12441Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
12442 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
12443 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
12444 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
12445
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000012446 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
12447 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
12448 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000012449
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012450 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
12451 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
12452 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
12453 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
12454 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000012455 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000012456 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
12457 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012458 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012459
12460 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
12461 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
12462
12463 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012464 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012465
12466 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
12467 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
12468 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
12469 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
12470
12471 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
12472 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
12473 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
12474 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
12475 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
12476 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
12477 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
12478 // Build a new shuffle mask.
12479 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
12480 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012481 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012482 else {
12483 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012484 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context),
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012485 NumVectorElts));
12486 }
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012487 Mask[InsertedIdx] =
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012488 ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012489 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +000012490 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012491 }
12492
12493 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
12494 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
12495 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
12496 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012497 Value *RHS = 0;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012498 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS, Context);
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012499 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012500 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012501 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS,
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +000012502 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012503 }
12504 }
12505 }
12506
Eli Friedmanb9a4cac2009-06-06 20:08:03 +000012507 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(VecOp->getType())->getNumElements();
12508 APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
12509 APInt AllOnesEltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
12510 if (SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&IE, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts))
12511 return &IE;
12512
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012513 return 0;
12514}
12515
12516
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012517Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
12518 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
12519 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012520 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012521
12522 bool MadeChange = false;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012523
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012524 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012525 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012526 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000012527
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000012528 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(SVI.getType())->getNumElements();
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012529
12530 if (VWidth != cast<VectorType>(LHS->getType())->getNumElements())
12531 return 0;
12532
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +000012533 APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
12534 APInt AllOnesEltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
12535 if (SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&SVI, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts)) {
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000012536 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
12537 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000012538 MadeChange = true;
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000012539 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012540
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012541 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
12542 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
12543 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
12544 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012545 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
12546 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
12547 }
12548
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012549 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
12550 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
12551 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012552 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012553 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012554 else {
12555 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000012556 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS))) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012557 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012558 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000012559 } else {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012560 Mask[i] = Mask[i] % e; // Force to LHS.
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012561 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), Mask[i]));
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000012562 }
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012563 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012564 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012565 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012566 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +000012567 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012568 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
12569 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012570 MadeChange = true;
12571 }
12572
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012573 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012574 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000012575
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012576 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
12577 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
12578 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
12579 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
12580
12581 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
12582 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000012583 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012584
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012585 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
12586 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
12587 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012588
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012589 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
12590 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
12591 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
12592 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
12593 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
12594 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
12595 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
12596 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
12597 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
12598 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
12599 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
12600 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
12601
12602 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
12603 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
12604 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
12605 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
12606 else
12607 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
12608
12609 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
12610 // the replacement.
12611 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
Mon P Wangfe6d2cd2009-01-26 04:39:00 +000012612 unsigned LHSInNElts =
12613 cast<VectorType>(LHSSVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012614 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
12615 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Mon P Wangfe6d2cd2009-01-26 04:39:00 +000012616 if (NewMask[i] >= LHSInNElts*2) {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012617 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context)));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012618 } else {
Owen Anderson1d0be152009-08-13 21:58:54 +000012619 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(*Context), NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012620 }
12621 }
12622 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
12623 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Owen Andersonaf7ec972009-07-28 21:19:26 +000012624 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012625 }
12626 }
12627 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000012628
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012629 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
12630}
12631
12632
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012633
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012634
12635/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
12636/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
12637/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
12638/// end of its block.
12639static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
12640 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
12641
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000012642 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Duncan Sands7af1c782009-05-06 06:49:50 +000012643 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayHaveSideEffects() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
Chris Lattnerbfc538c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000012644 return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000012645
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012646 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000012647 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
12648 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012649 return false;
12650
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000012651 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
12652 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000012653 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
12654 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000012655 Scan != E; ++Scan)
12656 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
12657 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000012658 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012659
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000012660 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012661
Dale Johannesenbd8e6502009-03-03 01:09:07 +000012662 CopyPrecedingStopPoint(I, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000012663 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012664 ++NumSunkInst;
12665 return true;
12666}
12667
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012668
12669/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
12670/// all reachable code to the worklist.
12671///
12672/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
12673/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
12674/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
12675/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
12676/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
12677///
12678static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000012679 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012680 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012681 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000012682 SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012683 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012684
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012685 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
12686 BB = Worklist.back();
12687 Worklist.pop_back();
12688
12689 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
12690 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000012691
12692 DbgInfoIntrinsic *DBI_Prev = NULL;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012693 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
12694 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012695
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012696 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
12697 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
12698 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012699 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst << '\n');
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012700 Inst->eraseFromParent();
12701 continue;
12702 }
12703
12704 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
Owen Anderson50895512009-07-06 18:42:36 +000012705 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, BB->getContext(), TD)) {
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012706 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: "
12707 << *Inst << '\n');
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012708 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
12709 ++NumConstProp;
12710 Inst->eraseFromParent();
12711 continue;
12712 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000012713
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000012714 // If there are two consecutive llvm.dbg.stoppoint calls then
12715 // it is likely that the optimizer deleted code in between these
12716 // two intrinsics.
12717 DbgInfoIntrinsic *DBI_Next = dyn_cast<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(Inst);
12718 if (DBI_Next) {
12719 if (DBI_Prev
12720 && DBI_Prev->getIntrinsicID() == llvm::Intrinsic::dbg_stoppoint
12721 && DBI_Next->getIntrinsicID() == llvm::Intrinsic::dbg_stoppoint) {
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012722 IC.Worklist.Remove(DBI_Prev);
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000012723 DBI_Prev->eraseFromParent();
12724 }
12725 DBI_Prev = DBI_Next;
Zhou Sheng8313ef42009-02-23 10:14:11 +000012726 } else {
12727 DBI_Prev = 0;
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000012728 }
12729
Chris Lattner61488a32009-10-11 21:05:34 +000012730 IC.Worklist.Add(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012731 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012732
12733 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
12734 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
12735 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
12736 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
12737 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
12738 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000012739 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000012740 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012741 continue;
12742 }
12743 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
12744 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
12745 // See if this is an explicit destination.
12746 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
12747 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000012748 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000012749 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012750 continue;
12751 }
12752
12753 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
12754 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
12755 continue;
12756 }
12757 }
12758
12759 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
12760 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012761 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012762}
12763
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012764bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012765 MadeIRChange = false;
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000012766 TD = getAnalysisIfAvailable<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012767
Daniel Dunbarce63ffb2009-07-25 00:23:56 +000012768 DEBUG(errs() << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
12769 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012770
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012771 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012772 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
12773 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
12774 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000012775 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012776 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000012777
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012778 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
12779 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
12780 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
12781 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
12782 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
12783 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
12784 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
12785 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000012786
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012787 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: DCE: " << *I << '\n');
Dale Johannesenff278b12009-03-10 21:19:49 +000012788 // A debug intrinsic shouldn't force another iteration if we weren't
12789 // going to do one without it.
12790 if (!isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(I)) {
12791 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012792 MadeIRChange = true;
Dale Johannesenff278b12009-03-10 21:19:49 +000012793 }
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012794 if (!I->use_empty())
Owen Anderson9e9a0d52009-07-30 23:03:37 +000012795 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012796 I->eraseFromParent();
12797 }
12798 }
12799 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012800
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000012801 while (!Worklist.isEmpty()) {
12802 Instruction *I = Worklist.RemoveOne();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012803 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012804
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012805 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012806 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012807 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: DCE: " << *I << '\n');
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012808 EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
12809 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012810 MadeIRChange = true;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012811 continue;
12812 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012813
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012814 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Owen Anderson50895512009-07-06 18:42:36 +000012815 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, F.getContext(), TD)) {
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012816 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I << '\n');
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000012817
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012818 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000012819 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012820 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012821 EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012822 MadeIRChange = true;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012823 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012824 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012825
Eli Friedmanfd2934f2009-07-15 22:13:34 +000012826 if (TD) {
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000012827 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
Chris Lattner1e19d602009-01-31 07:04:22 +000012828 for (User::op_iterator i = I->op_begin(), e = I->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
12829 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i))
Owen Anderson50895512009-07-06 18:42:36 +000012830 if (Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE,
12831 F.getContext(), TD))
Chris Lattner1e19d602009-01-31 07:04:22 +000012832 if (NewC != CE) {
Dan Gohmane41a1152009-10-05 16:31:55 +000012833 *i = NewC;
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012834 MadeIRChange = true;
Chris Lattner1e19d602009-01-31 07:04:22 +000012835 }
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000012836 }
12837
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012838 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Dan Gohmanfc74abf2008-07-23 00:34:11 +000012839 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012840 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
12841 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
12842 if (UserParent != BB) {
12843 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
12844 // See if the user is one of our successors.
12845 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
12846 if (*SI == UserParent) {
12847 UserIsSuccessor = true;
12848 break;
12849 }
12850
12851 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
12852 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
12853 // otherwise), we can keep going.
12854 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
12855 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
12856 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012857 MadeIRChange |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012858 }
12859 }
12860
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +000012861 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it.
12862 Builder->SetInsertPoint(I->getParent(), I);
12863
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000012864#ifndef NDEBUG
12865 std::string OrigI;
12866#endif
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012867 DEBUG(raw_string_ostream SS(OrigI); I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Jeffrey Yasskin43069632009-10-08 00:12:24 +000012868 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: Visiting: " << OrigI << '\n');
12869
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012870 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000012871 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012872 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000012873 if (Result != I) {
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012874 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: Old = " << *I << '\n'
12875 << " New = " << *Result << '\n');
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000012876
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012877 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
12878 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
12879
12880 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012881 Worklist.Add(Result);
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +000012882 Worklist.AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012883
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000012884 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
12885 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012886
12887 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
12888 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000012889 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
12890
12891 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
12892 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
12893 ++InsertPos;
12894
12895 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012896
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012897 EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000012898 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000012899#ifndef NDEBUG
Chris Lattnerbdff5482009-08-23 04:37:46 +000012900 DEBUG(errs() << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI << '\n'
12901 << " New = " << *I << '\n');
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000012902#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000012903
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012904 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
12905 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012906 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012907 EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012908 } else {
Chris Lattner7a1e9242009-08-30 06:13:40 +000012909 Worklist.Add(I);
Chris Lattnere5ecdb52009-08-30 06:22:51 +000012910 Worklist.AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012911 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000012912 }
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012913 MadeIRChange = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012914 }
12915 }
12916
Chris Lattner873ff012009-08-30 05:55:36 +000012917 Worklist.Zap();
Chris Lattnerb0b822c2009-08-31 06:57:37 +000012918 return MadeIRChange;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012919}
12920
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012921
12922bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000012923 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
Owen Andersone922c022009-07-22 00:24:57 +000012924 Context = &F.getContext();
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000012925
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +000012926
12927 /// Builder - This is an IRBuilder that automatically inserts new
12928 /// instructions into the worklist when they are created.
12929 IRBuilder<true, ConstantFolder, InstCombineIRInserter>
12930 TheBuilder(F.getContext(), ConstantFolder(F.getContext()),
12931 InstCombineIRInserter(Worklist));
12932 Builder = &TheBuilder;
12933
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012934 bool EverMadeChange = false;
12935
12936 // Iterate while there is work to do.
12937 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000012938 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012939 EverMadeChange = true;
Chris Lattner74381062009-08-30 07:44:24 +000012940
12941 Builder = 0;
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012942 return EverMadeChange;
12943}
12944
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000012945FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012946 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012947}